blob: 1b4be4dea570e036c1f015797e0c9b6ab76e260d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
632 running on the same host.
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100666ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
669 keyword to see available options.
670
671 Example:
672 global
673 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
674
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100675ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
677 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300678 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100679 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
680 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
681 information.
682
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100683ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
685 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
686 keyword to see available options.
687
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100688ssl-server-verify [none|required]
689 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
690 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
691 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
694 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
695 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
696 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
697 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200698
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200699 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
700 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
701 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200702
703stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
704 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
705 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100706 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200707
708stats maxconn <connections>
709 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
710 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712uid <number>
713 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
714 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
715 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
716 one. See also "gid" and "user".
717
718ulimit-n <number>
719 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
720 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
721 option.
722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100723unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
724 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
725
726 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
727 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
728 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
729 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
730 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
731 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
732 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
733 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
734 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
735 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737user <user name>
738 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
739 See also "uid" and "group".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200741node <name>
742 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
743
744 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
745 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
746 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
747 traffic.
748
749description <text>
750 Add a text that describes the instance.
751
752 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
753 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
754 "<" and ">" characters.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758-----------------------
759
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200760max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
761 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
762 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
763 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
764 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
765 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
766 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
767 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
768 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770maxconn <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
772 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
773 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200774 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
775 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
776 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
777 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
778 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200779
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200780maxconnrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100790maxcomprate <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300792 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100793 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
794 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
795 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
796 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
797 default value.
798
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100799maxcompcpuusage <number>
800 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
801 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
802 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
803 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
804 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
805 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
806 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
807 process down and from introducing high latencies.
808
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100809maxpipes <number>
810 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
811 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
812 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
813 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
814 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
815 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
816
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200817maxsessrate <number>
818 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
819 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
820 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
821 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
822 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
823 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
824 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
825 fairness.
826
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200827maxsslconn <number>
828 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
829 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
830 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
831 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
832 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
833 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
834 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
835
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200836maxsslrate <number>
837 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
838 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
839 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
840 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
841 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
842 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
843 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
844 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
845 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
846 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
847
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100848maxzlibmem <number>
849 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
850 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
851 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100852 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
853 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
854 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856noepoll
857 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
858 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100859 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
861nokqueue
862 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
863 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
864 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
865
866nopoll
867 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
868 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100869 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100870 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100872nosplice
873 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
874 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
875 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100876 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100877 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
878 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
879 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
880 "option splice-response".
881
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300882nogetaddrinfo
883 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
884 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
885
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200886spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900887 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
888 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
889 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
890 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
891 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
892 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200893
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100894tune.buffers.limit <number>
895 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
896 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
897 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
898 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
899 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
900 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
901 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
902 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
903 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
904 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
905 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
906 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
907 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
908 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
909 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
910
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100911tune.buffers.reserve <number>
912 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
913 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
914 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
915 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
916
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200917tune.bufsize <number>
918 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
919 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
920 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
921 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
922 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
923 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
924 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
925 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400926 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
927 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
928 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200929
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200930tune.chksize <number>
931 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
932 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
933 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
934 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
935 checks whenever possible.
936
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100937tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
938 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
939 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
940 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
941 this value. The default value is 1.
942
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100943tune.http.cookielen <number>
944 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
945 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
946 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
947 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
948 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
949 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
950 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
951 to change this value.
952
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200953tune.http.maxhdr <number>
954 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
955 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
956 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
957 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
958 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
959 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
960 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
961 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
962 limit too high.
963
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100964tune.idletimer <timeout>
965 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
966 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
967 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
968 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
969 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
970 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
971 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
972 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
973 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
974
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100975tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100976 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
977 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
978 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
979 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
980 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
981 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
982 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
983 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
984 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
985 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100986
987tune.maxpollevents <number>
988 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
989 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
990 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
991 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
992 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
993
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200994tune.maxrewrite <number>
995 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
996 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
997 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
998 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
999 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1000 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1001 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1002 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1003 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1004 bufsize.
1005
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001006tune.pipesize <number>
1007 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1008 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1009 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1010 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1011 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1012 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1013
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001014tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1015tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1016 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1017 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1018 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1019 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1020 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1021 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1022 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1023
1024tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1025tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1026 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1027 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1028 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1029 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1030 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1031 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1032 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1033 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1034 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1035 notifying haproxy again.
1036
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001037tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001038 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1039 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1040 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001041 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001042 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1043 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1044 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1045 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1046 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001047 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1048 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001049
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001050tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1051 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1052 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1053 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1054 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1055 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1056 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1057
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001058tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1059 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001060 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001061 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1062 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1063 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1064 being used for too long.
1065
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001066tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1067 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1068 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1069 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1070 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1071 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1072 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1073 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1074 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1075 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1076 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001077 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1078 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001079
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001080tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1081 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1082 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1083 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1084 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1085 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1086 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1087 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1088 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1089
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001090tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1091 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001092 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001093 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1094 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1095 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1096
1097tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1098 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1099 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1100 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1101 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011033.3. Debugging
1104--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105
1106debug
1107 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1108 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1109 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1110 system startup.
1111
1112quiet
1113 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1114 line argument "-q".
1115
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001116
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011173.4. Userlists
1118--------------
1119It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1120http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1121it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1122
1123userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001124 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1126
1127group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001128 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1130 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1131
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001132user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1133 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001134 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1135 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001136 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1137 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001138 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001139 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001140
1141
1142 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001143 userlist L1
1144 group G1 users tiger,scott
1145 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001146
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001147 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1148 user scott insecure-password elgato
1149 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001150
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001151 userlist L2
1152 group G1
1153 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001154
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001155 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1156 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1157 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001158
1159 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001161
11623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001163----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001164It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1165haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1166pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1167identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1168or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1169Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1170known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1171the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1172process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1173during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1174tables.
1175
1176peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001177 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001178 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1179
1180peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1181 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1182 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1183 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1184 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1185 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1186 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1187
1188 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1189 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1190
1191 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1192 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1193 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1194 across all peers.
1195
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001196 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1197 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1198 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1199
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001200 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001201 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001202 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1203 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1204 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001205
1206 backend mybackend
1207 mode tcp
1208 balance roundrobin
1209 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1210 stick on src
1211
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001212 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1213 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001214
1215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012164. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001219Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1220 - defaults <name>
1221 - frontend <name>
1222 - backend <name>
1223 - listen <name>
1224
1225A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1226its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1227section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001228section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001229
1230A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1231connections.
1232
1233A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1234to forward incoming connections.
1235
1236A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1237parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1238
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001239All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1240'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1241case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1242
1243Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1244logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1245proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1246However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1247name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1248
1249Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1250and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001251bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001252protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1253modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1254arbitrary criteria.
1255
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001256In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1257a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1258the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1259
1260 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1261 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1262 between responses and new requests.
1263
1264 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1265 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1266 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1267 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1268
1269 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1270 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1271 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1272
1273 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1274 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1275 client-facing connection remains open.
1276
1277 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1278 after the end of the response.
1279
1280The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1281frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1282following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1283weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1284
1285 Backend mode
1286
1287 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1288 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1289 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1290 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1291 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1292 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1293 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1294 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1295 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1296 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1297 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1298
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001299
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013014.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1302--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001304The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1305limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1306they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1307limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001309option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001310and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1311with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1312specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001313
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001314
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1316------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1317acl - X X X
1318appsession - - X X
1319backlog X X X -
1320balance X - X X
1321bind - X X -
1322bind-process X X X X
1323block - X X X
1324capture cookie - X X -
1325capture request header - X X -
1326capture response header - X X -
1327clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001328compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001329contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1330cookie X - X X
1331default-server X - X X
1332default_backend X X X -
1333description - X X X
1334disabled X X X X
1335dispatch - - X X
1336enabled X X X X
1337errorfile X X X X
1338errorloc X X X X
1339errorloc302 X X X X
1340-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1341errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001342force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001343fullconn X - X X
1344grace X X X X
1345hash-type X - X X
1346http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001347http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001348http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001349http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001350http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001351http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001352id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001353ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001354log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001355log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001356max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357maxconn X X X -
1358mode X X X X
1359monitor fail - X X -
1360monitor-net X X X -
1361monitor-uri X X X -
1362option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1363option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1364option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1365option allbackups (*) X - X X
1366option checkcache (*) X - X X
1367option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1368option contstats (*) X X X -
1369option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1370option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1371option forceclose (*) X X X X
1372-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1373option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001374option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001375option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001376option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001377option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001378option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001379option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1380option httpchk X - X X
1381option httpclose (*) X X X X
1382option httplog X X X X
1383option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001384option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001385option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001386option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001387option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1388option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1389option logasap (*) X X X -
1390option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001391option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001392option nolinger (*) X X X X
1393option originalto X X X X
1394option persist (*) X - X X
1395option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001396option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001397option smtpchk X - X X
1398option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1399option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1400option splice-request (*) X X X X
1401option splice-response (*) X X X X
1402option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1403option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1404-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001405option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001406option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1407option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1408option tcpka X X X X
1409option tcplog X X X X
1410option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001411external-check command X - X X
1412external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001413persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1414rate-limit sessions X X X -
1415redirect - X X X
1416redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1417redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1418reqadd - X X X
1419reqallow - X X X
1420reqdel - X X X
1421reqdeny - X X X
1422reqiallow - X X X
1423reqidel - X X X
1424reqideny - X X X
1425reqipass - X X X
1426reqirep - X X X
1427reqisetbe - X X X
1428reqitarpit - X X X
1429reqpass - X X X
1430reqrep - X X X
1431-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1432reqsetbe - X X X
1433reqtarpit - X X X
1434retries X - X X
1435rspadd - X X X
1436rspdel - X X X
1437rspdeny - X X X
1438rspidel - X X X
1439rspideny - X X X
1440rspirep - X X X
1441rsprep - X X X
1442server - - X X
1443source X - X X
1444srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001445stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001446stats auth X - X X
1447stats enable X - X X
1448stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001449stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001450stats realm X - X X
1451stats refresh X - X X
1452stats scope X - X X
1453stats show-desc X - X X
1454stats show-legends X - X X
1455stats show-node X - X X
1456stats uri X - X X
1457-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1458stick match - - X X
1459stick on - - X X
1460stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001461stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001463tcp-check connect - - X X
1464tcp-check expect - - X X
1465tcp-check send - - X X
1466tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001467tcp-request connection - X X -
1468tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001469tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001470tcp-response content - - X X
1471tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001472timeout check X - X X
1473timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001474timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001475timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1476timeout connect X - X X
1477timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1478timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1479timeout http-request X X X X
1480timeout queue X - X X
1481timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001482timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001483timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1484timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001485timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001486transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001487unique-id-format X X X -
1488unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001489use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001490use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001491------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1492 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014954.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1496---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001497
1498This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1499
1500
1501acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1502 Declare or complete an access list.
1503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1504 no | yes | yes | yes
1505 Example:
1506 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1507 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1508 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001510 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001511
1512
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001513appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1514 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001515 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1517 no | no | yes | yes
1518 Arguments :
1519 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1520 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1521
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001522 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001523 checked in each cookie value.
1524
1525 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1526 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1527 milliseconds.
1528
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001529 request-learn
1530 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1531 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1532 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1533 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1534 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1535 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1536
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001537 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1538 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1539 data following this prefix.
1540
1541 Example :
1542 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1543
1544 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1545 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1546
1547 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1548 2 modes are currently supported :
1549 - path-parameters :
1550 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1551 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1552 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1553 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1554 - query-string :
1555 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1556 query string.
1557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001558 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1559 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1560 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1561 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001562 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1563 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1564 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1566 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1567
1568 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1569
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001570 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1571 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1572 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574 Example :
1575 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1576
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001577 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1578 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001579
1580
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001581backlog <conns>
1582 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1584 yes | yes | yes | no
1585 Arguments :
1586 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1587 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001588 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001589
1590 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1591 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1592 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1593 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1594 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1595 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1596 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1597 backlog parameter.
1598
1599 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1600 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1601 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1602
1603 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1604
1605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001607balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001608 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1610 yes | no | yes | yes
1611 Arguments :
1612 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1613 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1614 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1615 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1616
1617 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1618 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1619 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1620 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001621 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001622 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001623 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1624 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1625 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1626 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1627 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1628 it, so that you don't worry.
1629
1630 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1631 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1632 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1633 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1634 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1635 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1636 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1637 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001638
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001639 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1640 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1641 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1642 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1643 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1644 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1645 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1646 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1647
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001648 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001649 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001650 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1651 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001652 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001653 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1654 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1655 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1656 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1657 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001658 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1659 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1660 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1661 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1662 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1663 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001664
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001665 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1666 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1667 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1668 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1669 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1670 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1671 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1672 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001673 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001674 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001675 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1676 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1677 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001679 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1680 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1681 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1682 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1683 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1684 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1685 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1686 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1687 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1688 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1689 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1690 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001692 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001693 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1694 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1695 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1696 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1697 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1698 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1699 URIs start with a leading "/".
1700
1701 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1702 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1703 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1704 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001706 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001707 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1708
1709 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001710 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1711 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001712 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1713 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1714 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1715 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001716 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001717 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1718 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001719
1720 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1721 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1722 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1723 server will receive the request.
1724
1725 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1726 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1727 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1728 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1729 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001730 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1731 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1732 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001734 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1735 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1736 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1737 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1738 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001740 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001741 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1742 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1743 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1744
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001745 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1746 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1747 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1748
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001749 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001750 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001751 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1752 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1753 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1754 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1755 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1756 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001757 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001758 used instead.
1759
1760 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1761 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1762 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1763 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1764
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001765 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1766 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1767 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1768
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001769 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001772 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1773 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001774
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001775 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1776 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1777 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001778
1779 Examples :
1780 balance roundrobin
1781 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001782 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001783 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1784 balance hdr(host)
1785 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001786
1787 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1788 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001790 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001791 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1792 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1793 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1794 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1795
1796 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1797 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1798 defaults to 16 kB.
1799
1800 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1801 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1802
1803 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1804 Round Robin.
1805
1806 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1807 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1808 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1809 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1810
1811 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1812
1813 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001814 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001815 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1816 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1817 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001819 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1820 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
1822
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001823bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1824bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1827 no | yes | yes | no
1828 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001829 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1830 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1831 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1832 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001833 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001834 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1835 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1836 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1837 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1838 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1839 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1840 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001841 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1842 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1843 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1844 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1845 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1846 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1847 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001848 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1849 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1850 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001851 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1852 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1853 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1854 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001855
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001856 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1857 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001858 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1859 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1860 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001861 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1862 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1863 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1864 the range.
1865
1866 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1867 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1868 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1869 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1870 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1871 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1872 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001873 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001874 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1877 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1878 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1879 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1880 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1881 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1882 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1883 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1884
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001885 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1886 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1887 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1888 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001889
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1891 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1892 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1893 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1894 in a frontend.
1895
1896 Example :
1897 listen http_proxy
1898 bind :80,:443
1899 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001900 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001902 listen http_https_proxy
1903 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001904 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001905
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001906 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1907 bind ipv6@:80
1908 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1909 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1910
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001911 listen external_bind_app1
1912 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1913
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001914 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001915 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001916
1917
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001918bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001919 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1921 yes | yes | yes | yes
1922 Arguments :
1923 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1924 may be used to override a default value.
1925
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001926 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927 option may be combined with other numbers.
1928
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001929 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001930 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1931 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1932 missing from all processes.
1933
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001934 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001935 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001936 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1937 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1938 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1939 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001940
1941 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1942 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1943 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1944 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1945 and 'even' instances.
1946
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001947 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1948 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1949 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1950 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001951
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001952 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1953 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1954
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001955 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1956 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1957 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1958
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001959 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1960 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1961
1962 Example :
1963 listen app_ip1
1964 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001965 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001966
1967 listen app_ip2
1968 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001969 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001970
1971 listen management
1972 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001973 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001974
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001975 listen management
1976 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1977 bind-process 1-4
1978
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001979 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001980
1981
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982block { if | unless } <condition>
1983 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1985 no | yes | yes | yes
1986
1987 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1988 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001989 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001990 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001991 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1992 "block" statements per instance.
1993
1994 Example:
1995 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1996 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1997 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1998 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002000 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001
2002
2003capture cookie <name> len <length>
2004 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2006 no | yes | yes | no
2007 Arguments :
2008 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2009 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2010 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2011 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2012 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2013
2014 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2015 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2016 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2017 right if it exceeds <length>.
2018
2019 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2020 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2021 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2022 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2023
2024 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2025 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2026 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2027
2028 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2029 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2030 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002031 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2032 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2033 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034
2035 Example:
2036 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2037
2038 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002039 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040
2041
2042capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002043 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2045 no | yes | yes | no
2046 Arguments :
2047 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002048 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002049 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2050 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2051 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2052
2053 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2054 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2055 it exceeds <length>.
2056
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002057 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2059 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002060 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2061 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2062 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2063 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002064 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002065 environments to find where the request came from.
2066
2067 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2068 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2069 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2070 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002072 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2073 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2074 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2075 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2076 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077
2078 Example:
2079 capture request header Host len 15
2080 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2081 capture request header Referrer len 15
2082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002083 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084 about logging.
2085
2086
2087capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002088 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2090 no | yes | yes | no
2091 Arguments :
2092 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002093 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2095 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2096 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2097
2098 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2099 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2100 it exceeds <length>.
2101
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002102 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2104 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2105 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002106 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2107 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2108 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2109 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002110
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002111 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2112 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2113 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2114 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2115 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116
2117 Example:
2118 capture response header Content-length len 9
2119 capture response header Location len 15
2120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002121 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122 about logging.
2123
2124
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002125clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2128 yes | yes | yes | no
2129 Arguments :
2130 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2131 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2132 as explained at the top of this document.
2133
2134 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2135 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2136 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2137 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2138 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2139 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2140 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2141 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002142 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002143 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2144 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2145
2146 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2147 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2148 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2149 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2150 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2151 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2152
2153 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2154 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2155
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002156 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2157 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002159compression algo <algorithm> ...
2160compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002161compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002162 Enable HTTP compression.
2163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2164 yes | yes | yes | yes
2165 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002166 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2167 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2168 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2169
2170 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002171 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002172 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2173 data.
2174
2175 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2176 support for zlib was built in.
2177
2178 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2179 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2180 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2181 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2182 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2183 in.
2184
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002185 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002186 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002187 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2188 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2189 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2190 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2191 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002192
2193 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2194 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2195 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2196 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2197 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002198 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2199 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2200 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2201 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2202 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002203 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2204 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002205
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002206 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002207 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2208 "Accept-Encoding" header
2209 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002210 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002211 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2212 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002213 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2214 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2215 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2216 "multipart"
2217 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2218 header
2219 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2220 and later
2221 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2222 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002223
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002224 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2225 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002226
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002227 Examples :
2228 compression algo gzip
2229 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002230
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002231contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2234 yes | no | yes | yes
2235 Arguments :
2236 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2237 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2238 as explained at the top of this document.
2239
2240 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002241 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002242 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2244 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2245 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2246 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2247
2248 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2249 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2250 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2251 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2252 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2253 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2254
2255 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2256 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2257 instead.
2258
2259 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2260 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2261
2262
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002263cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002264 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2265 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002266 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2268 yes | no | yes | yes
2269 Arguments :
2270 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2271 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2272 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2273 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2274 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2275 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2276 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2277 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2278 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2279
2280 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2281 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2282 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2283 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2284 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2285 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2286 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2287 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2288 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2289 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2290 "insert" and "prefix".
2291
2292 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002293 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002294
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002295 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002296 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2297 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2298 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2299 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2300 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2301 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2302 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2303 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2304 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2305 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306
2307 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2308 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2309 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2310 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2311 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2312 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2313 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2314 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2315 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2316 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002317 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2318 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2319 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002321 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2322 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2323 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002324 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2325 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2326 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2327 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002328 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2329 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2330 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002331
2332 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2333 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2334 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2335 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2336 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2337 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2338 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2339 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2340 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2341
2342 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2343 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2344 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2345 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2346 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2347 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2348 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2349 persistence cookie in the cache.
2350 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2351
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002352 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2353 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2354 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2355 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2356 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2357 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2358 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2359 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2360 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2361 they logout.
2362
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002363 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2364 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2365 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2366 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2367
2368 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2369 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2370 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2371 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2372 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2373 this attribute.
2374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002375 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002376 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002377 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2378 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2379 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2380 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2381 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2382 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002383
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002384 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2385 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2386 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2387 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2388 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2389 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2390 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2391 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2392 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2393 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2394 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2395 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2396 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2397 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2398 the site.
2399
2400 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2401 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2402 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2403 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2404 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2405 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2406 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2407 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2408 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2409 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2410 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2411 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2412 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2413 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2414 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2415 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2418 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2419 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2420 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422 Examples :
2423 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2424 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2425 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002426 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002427
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002428 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002429 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002432default-server [param*]
2433 Change default options for a server in a backend
2434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2435 yes | no | yes | yes
2436 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002437 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2438 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2439 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2440 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002441
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002442 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002443 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2444
2445 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002446
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002447
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002448default_backend <backend>
2449 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | yes | yes | no
2452 Arguments :
2453 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2454
2455 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2456 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2457 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2458 will catch all undetermined requests.
2459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460 Example :
2461
2462 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2463 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2464 default_backend dynamic
2465
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002466 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002469description <string>
2470 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2472 no | yes | yes | yes
2473 Arguments : string
2474
2475 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2476 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2477 it describes.
2478 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2479
2480
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002481disabled
2482 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 yes | yes | yes | yes
2485 Arguments : none
2486
2487 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2488 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2489 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2490 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2491 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2492 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2493 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2494
2495 See also : "enabled"
2496
2497
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002498dispatch <address>:<port>
2499 Set a default server address
2500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2501 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002502 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002503
2504 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2505 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2506 during start-up.
2507
2508 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2509 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2510 possible with normal servers.
2511
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002512 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002513 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2514 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2515 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2516 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2517
2518 See also : "server"
2519
2520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521enabled
2522 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2524 yes | yes | yes | yes
2525 Arguments : none
2526
2527 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2528 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2529
2530 See also : "disabled"
2531
2532
2533errorfile <code> <file>
2534 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2536 yes | yes | yes | yes
2537 Arguments :
2538 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002539 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002540
2541 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002542 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002544 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2545 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546
2547 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2548 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2549 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2550
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002551 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2552
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002553 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2554 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2555 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2556 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2557
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002558 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2559 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2560 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2561 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2562 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2563 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002565 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2566 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2567 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002568 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2570
2571 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2572
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002573 Example :
2574 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002575 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002576 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2577 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2578
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002579
2580errorloc <code> <url>
2581errorloc302 <code> <url>
2582 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2584 yes | yes | yes | yes
2585 Arguments :
2586 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002587 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002588
2589 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2590 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2591 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2592 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2593 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2594
2595 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2596 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2597 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2598
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002599 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2600
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002601 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2602 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2603 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2604 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2605 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2606 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2607 request.
2608
2609 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2610
2611
2612errorloc303 <code> <url>
2613 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2615 yes | yes | yes | yes
2616 Arguments :
2617 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2618 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2619
2620 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2621 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2622 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2623 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2624 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2625
2626 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2627 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2628 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2629
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002630 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2631
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002632 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2633 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2634 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2635 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002636 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002637
2638 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2639
2640
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002641force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2642 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2644 no | yes | yes | yes
2645
2646 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2647 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2648 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2649 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2650 marked down for maintenance operations.
2651
2652 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2653 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2654 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2655 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2656 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2657 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2658 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2659 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2660 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2661
2662 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2663 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2664 is used.
2665
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002666 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002667 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002668
2669
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002670fullconn <conns>
2671 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2673 yes | no | yes | yes
2674 Arguments :
2675 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2676 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2677
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002678 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002679 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002680 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002681 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2682 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2683 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2684 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2685 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002686 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002687
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002688 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2689 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002690 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2691 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2692 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002694 Example :
2695 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2696 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2697 # connections.
2698 backend dynamic
2699 fullconn 10000
2700 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2701 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2702
2703 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2704
2705
2706grace <time>
2707 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002709 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002710 Arguments :
2711 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2712 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2713 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2714
2715 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2716 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002717 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002718 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2719
2720 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2721 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2722 simplify it.
2723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002725hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002726 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2728 yes | no | yes | yes
2729 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002730 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2731 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002732
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002733 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2734 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2735 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2736 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2737 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2738 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2739 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2740 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2741 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2742 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002743
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002744 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2745 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2746 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2747 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2748 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2749 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2750 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2751 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2752 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2753 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2754 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2755 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2756 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002757 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2758 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002759
2760 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2761
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002762 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002763 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2764 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2765 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002766 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2767 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2768 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002769
2770 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2771 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002772 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2773 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2774 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2775 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2776
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002777 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2778 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2779 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2780 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2781 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2782 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2783 parameter.
2784
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002785 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2786
2787 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2788 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2789 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2790 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2791 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2792 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2793 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2794 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2795 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2796 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2797 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2798 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002799
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002800 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2801 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2802 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002803
2804 See also : "balance", "server"
2805
2806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002807http-check disable-on-404
2808 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002810 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 Arguments : none
2812
2813 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2814 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2815 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2816 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2817 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2818 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2819 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2820 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002821 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2822 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2823 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2824
2825 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2826
2827
2828http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002829 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002831 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002832 Arguments :
2833 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2834 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002835 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002836 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2837 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2838 details on the supported keywords.
2839
2840 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2841 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2842 with the usual backslash ('\').
2843
2844 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2845 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2846 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2847 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2848 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2849
2850 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002851 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002852 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2853 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2854 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2855
2856 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002857 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002858 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2859 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2860 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2861 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2862
2863 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002864 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002865 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2866 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2867 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2868 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2869 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2870 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2871 trace).
2872
2873 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002874 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002875 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2876 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2877 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2878 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2879 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2880 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2881
2882 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2883 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2884 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2885 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2886 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2887 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2888 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2889 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2890
2891 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2892 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2893
2894 Examples :
2895 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002896 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002897
2898 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002899 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002900
2901 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002902 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002903
2904 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002905 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002906
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002907 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002908
2909
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002910http-check send-state
2911 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2913 yes | no | yes | yes
2914 Arguments : none
2915
2916 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2917 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2918 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2919 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2920 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2921
2922 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2923 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2924 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2925 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2926 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2927 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2928 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2929 checked in multiple backends.
2930
2931 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2932 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2933
2934 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2935 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2936 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2937 one fails.
2938
2939 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2940 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2941 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2942
2943 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2944 server's queue.
2945
2946 Example of a header received by the application server :
2947 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2948 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2949
2950 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2951
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002952http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002953 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002954 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002955 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2956 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002957 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2958 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2959 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2960 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02002961 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
2962 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002963 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002964 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002965 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2966
2967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2968 no | yes | yes | yes
2969
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002970 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2971 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2972 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2973 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2974 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002975
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002976 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2977 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2978 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2979
2980 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2981 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2982 are evaluated.
2983
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002984 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2985 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2986 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2987 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2988 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2989 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2990 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2991 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2992 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002993 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002994 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2995
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002996 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2997 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2998 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2999 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3000 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3001
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003002 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3003 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3004 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003005 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3006 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003007
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003008 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3009 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3010 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3011 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3012 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3013 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3014 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3015 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3016
3017 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3018 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3019 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3020 external users.
3021
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003022 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3023 <name>.
3024
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003025 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3026 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3027 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3028 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3029 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3030 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3031 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3032 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3033
3034 Example:
3035
3036 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3037
3038 applied to:
3039
3040 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3041
3042 outputs:
3043
3044 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3045
3046 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3047
3048 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3049 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3050 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3051 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3052 header.
3053
3054 Example:
3055
3056 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3057
3058 applied to:
3059
3060 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3061
3062 outputs:
3063
3064 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3065
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003066 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3067 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3068 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3069 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3070 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3071 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3072 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3073 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3074
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003075 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3076 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3077 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3078 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3079 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3080 another equipment.
3081
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003082 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3083 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3084 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3085 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3086 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3087 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3088 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3089 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3090
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003091 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3092 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3093 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3094 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3095 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3096 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3097 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3098 admin privileges.
3099
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003100 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3101 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3102 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3103 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3104 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3105 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3106 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3107 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3108
3109 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3110 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3111 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3112 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3113 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3114 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3115
3116 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3117 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3118 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3119 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3120 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3121 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3122
3123 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3124 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3125 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3126 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3127 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3128 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3129 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3130 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3131 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3132
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003133 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3134 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3135 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3136 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3137 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3138 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3139 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3140 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3141 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3142 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3143 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3144 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3145
3146 These actions take one or two arguments :
3147 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3148 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3149 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3150 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3151
3152 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3153 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3154 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3155 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3156
3157 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3158 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3159 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3160 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3161 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3162 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3163 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3164 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3165
3166 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3167 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3168 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3169 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3170 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3171
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003172 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3173
3174 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3175 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3176 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3177 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003178
3179 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003180 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3181 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3182 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003183
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003184 http-request allow if nagios
3185 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3186 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3187 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003188
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003189 Example:
3190 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003191 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003192
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003193 Example:
3194 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3195 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3196 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3197 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3198 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3199 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3200 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3201 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3202 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3203
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003204 Example:
3205 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3206 acl add path /addacl
3207 acl del path /delacl
3208
3209 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3210
3211 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3212 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3213
3214 Example:
3215 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3216 acl setmap path /setmap
3217 acl delmap path /delmap
3218
3219 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3220
3221 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3222 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3223
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003224 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3225 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003226
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003227http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003228 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003229 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3230 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003231 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3232 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3233 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3234 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3235 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3236 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003237 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003238 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3239
3240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3241 no | yes | yes | yes
3242
3243 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3244 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3245 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3246 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3247 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3248 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3249
3250 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3251 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3252 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3253 current section.
3254
3255 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3256 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3257 rules are evaluated.
3258
3259 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3260 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3261 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3262 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3263 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3264 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3265 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3266
3267 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3268 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3269 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3270 external users.
3271
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003272 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3273 <name>.
3274
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003275 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3276 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3277 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3278 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3279 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3280 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3281 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3282 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3283
3284 Example:
3285
3286 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3287
3288 applied to:
3289
3290 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3291
3292 outputs:
3293
3294 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3295
3296 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3297
3298 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3299 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3300 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3301 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3302 header.
3303
3304 Example:
3305
3306 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3307
3308 applied to:
3309
3310 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3311
3312 outputs:
3313
3314 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3315
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003316 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3317 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3318 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3319 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3320 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3321 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3322 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3323 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3324
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003325 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3326 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3327 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3328 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3329 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3330 another equipment.
3331
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003332 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3333 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3334 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3335 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3336 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3337 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3338 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3339 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3340
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003341 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3342 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3343 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3344 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3345 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3346 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3347 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3348 admin privileges.
3349
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003350 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3351 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3352 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3353 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3354 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3355 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3356 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3357 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3358
3359 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3360 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3361 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3362 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3363 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3364 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3365
3366 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3367 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3368 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3369 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3370 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3371 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3372
3373 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3374 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3375 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3376 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3377 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3378 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3379 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3380 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3381 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3382
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003383 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3384
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003385 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003386 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3387 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3388 rules.
3389
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003390 Example:
3391 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3392
3393 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3394
3395 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3396 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3397
3398 Example:
3399 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3400
3401 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3402
3403 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3404 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3405
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003406 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3407 ACL usage.
3408
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003409
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003410http-send-name-header [<header>]
3411 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3412
3413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 yes | no | yes | yes
3415
3416 Arguments :
3417
3418 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3419
3420 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3421 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3422 is added with the header string proved.
3423
3424 See also : "server"
3425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003426id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003427 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 no | yes | yes | yes
3430 Arguments : none
3431
3432 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3433 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3434 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003435
3436
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003437ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3438 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3439 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3440 no | yes | yes | yes
3441
3442 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3443 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3444 and running).
3445
3446 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3447 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3448 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003449 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003450 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3451
3452 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3453 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3454
3455 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3456 "unless" condition is met.
3457
3458 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3459
3460
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003461log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003462log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003463no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003464 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3466 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003467
3468 Prefix :
3469 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3470 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3471 prefix does not allow arguments.
3472
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003473 Arguments :
3474 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3475 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3476 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3477 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3478 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3479 parameter.
3480
3481 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3482 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3483
3484 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3485 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3486 standard syslog port).
3487
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003488 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3489 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3490 standard syslog port).
3491
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003492 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3493 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3494 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3495 appropriately writeable).
3496
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003497 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3498 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3499 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3500 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3501
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003502 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3503 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3504 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3505 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3506 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3507 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3508 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3509 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3510 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3511 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3512 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3513
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003514 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3515
3516 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3517 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3518 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3519
3520 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3521 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3522 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003523 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3524 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3525 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3526 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3527 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003528
3529 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3530
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003531 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3532 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3533 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003534
3535 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3536 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3537 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3538 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3539
3540 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3541 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003542
3543 Example :
3544 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003545 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3546 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003547 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3548
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003549
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003550log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003551 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3552 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3553 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003554
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003555 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3556 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3557 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3558 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3559 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003560
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003561
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003562max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3563 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3565 yes | no | yes | yes
3566
3567 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3568 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3569 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3570 servers.
3571
3572 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3573 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3574 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3575 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3576 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3577 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3578 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3579 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3580 picking a different server.
3581
3582 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3583 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3584 even if they have to be queued.
3585
3586 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3587 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3588
3589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003590maxconn <conns>
3591 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | yes | yes | no
3594 Arguments :
3595 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3596 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3597 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3598 closes.
3599
3600 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3601 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3602 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3603 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3604 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3605 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3606 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3607 properly tuned.
3608
3609 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3610 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3611 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3612
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003613 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3614
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3616
3617
3618mode { tcp|http|health }
3619 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3621 yes | yes | yes | yes
3622 Arguments :
3623 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3624 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3625 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3626 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3627
3628 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3629 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3630 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3631 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3632 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3633
3634 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003635 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3636 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3637 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3638 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3639 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3640 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3641 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003642
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003643 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3644 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3645 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003646
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003647 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648 defaults http_instances
3649 mode http
3650
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003651 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003653
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003654monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003655 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003658 Arguments :
3659 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3660 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003661 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003662 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3663 backend and its backup.
3664
3665 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3666 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3667 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3668 servers in a list of backends.
3669
3670 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3671 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3672 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3673 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3674 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3675 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3676 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003677 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3678 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679
3680 Example:
3681 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003682 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3684 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3685 monitor-uri /site_alive
3686 monitor fail if site_dead
3687
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003688 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003689
3690
3691monitor-net <source>
3692 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3694 yes | yes | yes | no
3695 Arguments :
3696 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3697 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3698 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3699 followed by a mask.
3700
3701 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3702 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003703 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003704 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3705
3706 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3707 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3708 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3709 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003710 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3711 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3712 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003713
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003714 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3715 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3716 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3717 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3718 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3719 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003720
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003721 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3722 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003723
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003724 Example :
3725 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3726 frontend www
3727 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3728
3729 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3730
3731
3732monitor-uri <uri>
3733 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3735 yes | yes | yes | no
3736 Arguments :
3737 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3738 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3739
3740 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3741 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3742 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3743 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3744 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3745 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3746 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3747 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3748
3749 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3750 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3751 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3752 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3753 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3754 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3755
3756 Example :
3757 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3758 frontend www
3759 mode http
3760 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3761
3762 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003764
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003765option abortonclose
3766no option abortonclose
3767 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3769 yes | no | yes | yes
3770 Arguments : none
3771
3772 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3773 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3774 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3775 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003776 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003777 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3778 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3779 encountered while delivering the response.
3780
3781 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3782 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3783 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3784 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3785 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3786 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003787 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003788 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003789 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003790 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3791 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3792 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3793
3794 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3795 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3796 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3797 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3798 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3799 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3800 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3801 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003802 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003803
3804 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3805 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3806
3807 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3808
3809
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003810option accept-invalid-http-request
3811no option accept-invalid-http-request
3812 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3814 yes | yes | yes | no
3815 Arguments : none
3816
3817 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3818 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3819 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3820 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3821 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3822 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3823 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3824 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003825 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3826 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3827 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3828 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3829 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3830 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003831
3832 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3833 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3834 been confirmed.
3835
3836 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3837 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003838 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3839 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003840 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3841
3842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3844
3845 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3846 stats socket.
3847
3848
3849option accept-invalid-http-response
3850no option accept-invalid-http-response
3851 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | no | yes | yes
3854 Arguments : none
3855
3856 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3857 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3858 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3859 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3860 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3861 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3862 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3863 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3864 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3865
3866 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3867 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3868 been confirmed.
3869
3870 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3871 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3872 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3873 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3874
3875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3877
3878 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3879 stats socket.
3880
3881
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003882option allbackups
3883no option allbackups
3884 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 yes | no | yes | yes
3887 Arguments : none
3888
3889 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3890 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3891 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3892 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3893 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3894 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3895 order between the backup servers anymore.
3896
3897 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3898 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3899
3900 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3901 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3902
3903
3904option checkcache
3905no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003906 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | no | yes | yes
3909 Arguments : none
3910
3911 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3912 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003913 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003914 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3915 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003916 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003917
3918 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003919 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003920 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003921 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3922 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003923 to the client are :
3924 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003925 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003926 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003927 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3928 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3929 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3930 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3931 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3932 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3933 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3934 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3935 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3936 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3937 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3938
3939 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003940 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003941 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003942 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003943 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3944
3945 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3946 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003947 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003948 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3949
3950 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3951 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3952
3953
3954option clitcpka
3955no option clitcpka
3956 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3958 yes | yes | yes | no
3959 Arguments : none
3960
3961 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3962 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3963 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3964 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3965
3966 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3967 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3968 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3969 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3970
3971 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3972 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3973 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3974 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3975 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3976
3977 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3978
3979 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3980 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3981 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3982
3983 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3984 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3985
3986 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3987
3988
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003989option contstats
3990 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 yes | yes | yes | no
3993 Arguments : none
3994
3995 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3996 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3997 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3998 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3999 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4000 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4001 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4002
4003
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004004option dontlog-normal
4005no option dontlog-normal
4006 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4008 yes | yes | yes | no
4009 Arguments : none
4010
4011 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4012 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4013 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4014 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4015 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4016 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4017 logged.
4018
4019 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4020 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4021 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004023 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004024 logging.
4025
4026
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004027option dontlognull
4028no option dontlognull
4029 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4031 yes | yes | yes | no
4032 Arguments : none
4033
4034 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4035 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4036 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4037 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4038 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4039 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4040 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4041
4042 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4043 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4044 would not be logged.
4045
4046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004049 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004050
4051
4052option forceclose
4053no option forceclose
4054 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004056 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004057 Arguments : none
4058
4059 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4060 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4061 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4062 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4063 global session times in the logs.
4064
4065 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004066 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004067 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004068
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004069 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4070 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4071 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4072
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004073 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4074 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004075
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004076 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4077 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4078
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004079 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004080
4081
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004082option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004083 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4085 yes | yes | yes | yes
4086 Arguments :
4087 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4088 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004089 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004090 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004091
4092 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4093 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4094 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4095 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4096 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4097 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4098 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004099 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4100 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4101 possible that the client has already brought one.
4102
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004103 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004104 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004105 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4106 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004107 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4108 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004109
4110 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4111 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4112 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4113 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4114 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4115 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4116 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4117
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004118 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4119 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4120 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4121 are under the control of the end-user.
4122
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004123 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004124 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4125 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004126 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4127 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4128 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004129
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004130 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004131 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4132 frontend www
4133 mode http
4134 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4135
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004136 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4137 backend www
4138 mode http
4139 option forwardfor header X-Client
4140
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004141 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004142 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004143
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004144
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004145option http-keep-alive
4146no option http-keep-alive
4147 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 yes | yes | yes | yes
4150 Arguments : none
4151
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004152 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4153 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4154 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4155 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4156 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4157 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4158 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4159
4160 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4161 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004162 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4163 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4164 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4165 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4166 situations where this option may be useful :
4167
4168 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4169 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4170
4171 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4172 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4173
4174 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4175 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4176 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4177 request.
4178
4179 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4180 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004181 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4182 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4183 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004184
4185 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4186 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4187
4188 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4189 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4190 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4191 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4192 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4193 not set.
4194
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004195 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4196 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004197 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004198 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004199
4200 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004201 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4202 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004203
4204
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004205option http-no-delay
4206no option http-no-delay
4207 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4209 yes | yes | yes | yes
4210 Arguments : none
4211
4212 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4213 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4214 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4215 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4216 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4217 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4218 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4219 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4220 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4221 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4222 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4223 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4224 affected.
4225
4226 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4227 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4228 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4229 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4230 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4231 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4232 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4233 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4234 latency environments.
4235
4236
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004237option http-pretend-keepalive
4238no option http-pretend-keepalive
4239 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 yes | yes | yes | yes
4242 Arguments : none
4243
4244 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4245 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4246 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4247 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4248 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4249 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4250 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4251 consider the response complete.
4252
4253 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4254 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4255 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4256 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4257 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4258 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4259
4260 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4261 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4262 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4263 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4264 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4265 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4266 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4267
4268 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4269 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004270 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004271 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4272 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004273
4274 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4275 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4276
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004277 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4278 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004279
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004280
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004281option http-server-close
4282no option http-server-close
4283 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4285 yes | yes | yes | yes
4286 Arguments : none
4287
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004288 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4289 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4290 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4291 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4292 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4293 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4294 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4295 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4296 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4297 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4298 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4299 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4300 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4301 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4302 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4303 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004304
4305 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4306 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4307 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4308 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004309 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4310 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004311
4312 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4313 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004314 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4315 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004316 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4317 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004318
4319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4321
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004322 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004323 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4324 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004325
4326
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004327option http-tunnel
4328no option http-tunnel
4329 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4331 yes | yes | yes | yes
4332 Arguments : none
4333
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004334 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4335 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4336 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4337 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4338 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4339 "option http-tunnel".
4340
4341 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004342 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004343 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4344 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4345 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4346 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4347 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4348 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4349 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004350
4351 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4352 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4353
4354 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4355 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4356 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4357
4358
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004359option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004360no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004361 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4363 yes | yes | yes | no
4364 Arguments : none
4365
4366 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4367 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4368 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4369 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4370 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4371 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4372 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4373
4374 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4375 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4376 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4377 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4378 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4379 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4380 request along its whole life.
4381
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004382 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4383 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4384 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4385 front of an existing proxy.
4386
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004387 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4388
4389 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4390 http-server-close".
4391
4392
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004393option httpchk
4394option httpchk <uri>
4395option httpchk <method> <uri>
4396option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4397 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400 Arguments :
4401 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4402 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4403 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4404 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4405 ones.
4406
4407 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4408 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4409 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4410
4411 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4412 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4413 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4414 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4415 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4416
4417 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4418 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4419 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4420 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4421 the lack of any response.
4422
4423 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4424
4425 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4426 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4427 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4428
4429 Examples :
4430 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4431 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4432 backend https_relay
4433 mode tcp
4434 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4435 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4436
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004437 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4438 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4439 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004440
4441
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004442option httpclose
4443no option httpclose
4444 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 yes | yes | yes | yes
4447 Arguments : none
4448
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004449 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4450 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4451 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4452 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004453 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004454 "option http-tunnel".
4455
4456 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4457 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4458 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4459 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4460 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4461 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4462 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4463 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004464
4465 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004466 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004467 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4468 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4469 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4470 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4471 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004472
4473 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4474 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004475 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4476 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004477 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4478 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004479
4480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4482
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004483 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4484 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004485
4486
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004487option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004488 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4490 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004491 Arguments :
4492 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4493 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4494 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4495 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4496 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004497
4498 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4499 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4500 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4501 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4502 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4503 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4504 ports.
4505
4506 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4507
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004508 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4509 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004511 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004512
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004513
4514option http_proxy
4515no option http_proxy
4516 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4518 yes | yes | yes | yes
4519 Arguments : none
4520
4521 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4522 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4523 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4524 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4525 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4526
4527 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4528 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4529 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4530 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004531 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004532 be analyzed.
4533
4534 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4535 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4536
4537 Example :
4538 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4539 backend direct_forward
4540 option httpclose
4541 option http_proxy
4542
4543 See also : "option httpclose"
4544
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004545
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004546option independent-streams
4547no option independent-streams
4548 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4550 yes | yes | yes | yes
4551 Arguments : none
4552
4553 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4554 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4555 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4556 receive data or not.
4557
4558 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4559 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4560 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4561 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4562 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4563 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4564 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4565 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4566 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4567 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4568 socket buffers.
4569
4570 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4571 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4572 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4573 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4574 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4575
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004576 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004577 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4578 deprecated.
4579
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004580 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004581
4582
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004583option ldap-check
4584 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4586 yes | no | yes | yes
4587 Arguments : none
4588
4589 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4590 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4591 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4592 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4593
4594 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4595 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4596
4597 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4598 configure it.
4599
4600 Example :
4601 option ldap-check
4602
4603 See also : "option httpchk"
4604
4605
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004606option external-check
4607 Use external processes for server health checks
4608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4609 yes | no | yes | yes
4610
4611 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4612 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4613 command".
4614
4615 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4616
4617 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4618
4619
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004620option log-health-checks
4621no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004622 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 yes | no | yes | yes
4625 Arguments : none
4626
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004627 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4628 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4629 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004630
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004631 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4632 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4633 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4634 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4635 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4636
4637 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4638 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004639
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004640 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4641 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4642 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004643
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004644
4645option log-separate-errors
4646no option log-separate-errors
4647 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4649 yes | yes | yes | no
4650 Arguments : none
4651
4652 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4653 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4654 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4655 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4656 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4657 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4658 provides very important information.
4659
4660 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4661 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4662 error logs.
4663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004664 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004665 logging.
4666
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004667
4668option logasap
4669no option logasap
4670 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4672 yes | yes | yes | no
4673 Arguments : none
4674
4675 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4676 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4677 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4678 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4679 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4680 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4681 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004682 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004683 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4684 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4685
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004686 Examples :
4687 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4688 mode http
4689 option httplog
4690 option logasap
4691 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4692
4693 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4694 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4695 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4696 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004698 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004699 logging.
4700
4701
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004702option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004703 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004706 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004707 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4708 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004709 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004710
4711 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4712 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4713 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4714 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4715 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4716 in the MySQL table, like this :
4717
4718 USE mysql;
4719 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4720 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4721
4722 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4723 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4724 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4725 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4726 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4727 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4728 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4729 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4730 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4731
4732 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4733 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004734
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004735 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004736
4737 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4738 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4739 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4740 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4741 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4742 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4743
4744 See also: "option httpchk"
4745
4746
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004747option nolinger
4748no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004749 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004752 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004753
4754 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4755 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4756 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4757 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4758 connections.
4759
4760 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4761 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4762 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4763 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4764 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4765 this too.
4766
4767 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4768 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4769 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4770
4771 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4772 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4773 for servers.
4774
4775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4777
4778
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004779option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4780 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4782 yes | yes | yes | yes
4783 Arguments :
4784 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4785 matching <network>
4786 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4787 header name.
4788
4789 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4790 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4791 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4792 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4793 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4794 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4795 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4796 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4797 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4798 possible that the client has already brought one.
4799
4800 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4801 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4802 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4803 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4804 header and requires different one.
4805
4806 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4807 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4808 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4809 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4810 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4811 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4812 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4813
4814 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4815 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4816 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4817 both are defined.
4818
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004819 Examples :
4820 # Original Destination address
4821 frontend www
4822 mode http
4823 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4824
4825 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4826 backend www
4827 mode http
4828 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4829
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004830 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4831 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004832
4833
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004834option persist
4835no option persist
4836 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4838 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004839 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004840
4841 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4842 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4843 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4844 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4845 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4846 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4847 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4848 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4849 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4850 redirected to another valid server.
4851
4852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4854
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004855 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004856
4857
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004858option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4859 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4861 yes | no | yes | yes
4862 Arguments :
4863 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4864 PostgreSQL server.
4865
4866 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4867 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4868 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4869 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4870
4871 See also: "option httpchk"
4872
4873
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004874option prefer-last-server
4875no option prefer-last-server
4876 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 yes | no | yes | yes
4879 Arguments : none
4880
4881 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4882 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4883 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4884 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4885 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4886 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4887 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4888 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4889 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004890 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4891 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4892 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4893 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4894 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4895 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4896 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004897
4898 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4899 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4900
4901 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4902
4903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004904option redispatch
4905no option redispatch
4906 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4907 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4908 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004909 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004910
4911 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4912 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4913 be able to access the service anymore.
4914
4915 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4916 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4917
4918 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4919 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4920 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004921
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004922 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4923 "redisp" keywords.
4924
4925 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4926 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4927
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004928 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004929
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004930
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004931option redis-check
4932 Use redis health checks for server testing
4933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | no | yes | yes
4935 Arguments : none
4936
4937 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4938 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4939 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4940 find the "+PONG" response message.
4941
4942 Example :
4943 option redis-check
4944
4945 See also : "option httpchk"
4946
4947
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004948option smtpchk
4949option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4950 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004953 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004954 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4955 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4956 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4957
4958 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4959 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4960 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4961
4962 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4963 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4964 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4965 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4966 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4967 dead server.
4968
4969 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4970 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4971 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4972 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4973
4974 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4975 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4976 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4977 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4978 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4979
4980 Example :
4981 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4982
4983 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004986option socket-stats
4987no option socket-stats
4988
4989 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4991 yes | yes | yes | no
4992
4993 Arguments : none
4994
4995
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004996option splice-auto
4997no option splice-auto
4998 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | yes
5001 Arguments : none
5002
5003 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5004 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5005 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5006 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005007 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005008 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5009 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5010 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5011 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5012
5013 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5014 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5015 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5016 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5017 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5018 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5019 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5020 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5021 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5022 keyword.
5023
5024 Example :
5025 option splice-auto
5026
5027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5029
5030 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5031 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5032
5033
5034option splice-request
5035no option splice-request
5036 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | yes | yes | yes
5039 Arguments : none
5040
5041 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005042 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005043 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5044 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5045 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5046 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5047
5048 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5049
5050 Example :
5051 option splice-request
5052
5053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5055
5056 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5057 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5058
5059
5060option splice-response
5061no option splice-response
5062 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | yes | yes | yes
5065 Arguments : none
5066
5067 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005068 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005069 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5070 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5071 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5072 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5073
5074 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5075
5076 Example :
5077 option splice-response
5078
5079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5081
5082 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5083 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5084
5085
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005086option srvtcpka
5087no option srvtcpka
5088 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5090 yes | no | yes | yes
5091 Arguments : none
5092
5093 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5094 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5095 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5096 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5097
5098 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5099 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5100 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5101 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5102
5103 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5104 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5105 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5106 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5107 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5108
5109 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5110
5111 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5112 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5113 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5114
5115 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5116 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5117
5118 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5119
5120
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005121option ssl-hello-chk
5122 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5124 yes | no | yes | yes
5125 Arguments : none
5126
5127 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5128 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5129 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5130 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5131 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5132 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5133 hello message.
5134
5135 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5136 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5137 messages, which is appreciable.
5138
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005139 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5140 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5141 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005142
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005143 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5144
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005145
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005146option tcp-check
5147 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5149 yes | no | yes | yes
5150
5151 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5152 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5153
5154 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5155 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5156 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5157
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005158 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005159 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5160 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5161 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5162 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5163 only.
5164
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005165 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005166 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5167 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5168 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5169 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5170
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005171 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005172 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5173 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005174 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005175 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5176 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5177 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5178 the respective protocols.
5179 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5180 analysed.
5181
5182 Examples :
5183 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5184 option tcp-check
5185 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5186
5187 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5188 option tcp-check
5189 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5190
5191 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5192 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005193 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005194 option tcp-check
5195 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5196 tcp-check expect +PONG
5197 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5198 tcp-check expect string role:master
5199 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5200 tcp-check expect string +OK
5201
5202 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5203 (send many headers before analyzing)
5204 option tcp-check
5205 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5206 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5207 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5208 tcp-check send \r\n
5209 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5210
5211
5212 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5213
5214
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005215option tcp-smart-accept
5216no option tcp-smart-accept
5217 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | yes | yes | no
5220 Arguments : none
5221
5222 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5223 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5224 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5225 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5226 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5227 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5228
5229 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5230 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5231 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5232 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5233
5234 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5235 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5236 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5237 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5238
5239 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5240 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5241 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5242
5243 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5244 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5245 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5246
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005247 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5248
5249
5250option tcp-smart-connect
5251no option tcp-smart-connect
5252 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5254 yes | no | yes | yes
5255 Arguments : none
5256
5257 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5258 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5259 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5260 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5261 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5262
5263 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5264 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5265 complex.
5266
5267 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5268 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5269 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5270
5271 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5272 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5273
5274 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5275
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005276
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005277option tcpka
5278 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5280 yes | yes | yes | yes
5281 Arguments : none
5282
5283 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5284 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5285 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5286 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5287
5288 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5289 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5290 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5291 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5292
5293 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5294 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5295 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5296 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5297 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5298
5299 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5300
5301 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5302 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5303 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5304 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5305 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5306 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5307 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5308 backends.
5309
5310 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5311
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005312
5313option tcplog
5314 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5316 yes | yes | yes | yes
5317 Arguments : none
5318
5319 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5320 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5321 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5322 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5323 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5324 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5325 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5326 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5327
5328 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005330 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005331
5332
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005333option transparent
5334no option transparent
5335 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005337 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005338 Arguments : none
5339
5340 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5341 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5342 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5343 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5344 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5345 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5346 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5347 appropriate server.
5348
5349 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5350 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5351
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005352 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005353 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005354
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005355
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005356external-check command <command>
5357 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5359 yes | no | yes | yes
5360
5361 Arguments :
5362 <command> is the external command to run
5363
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005364 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5365
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005366 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005367
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005368 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5369 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5370 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5371 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5372 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5373 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005374
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005375 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5376
5377 Environment variables :
5378 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5379 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5380
5381 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5382
5383 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5384
5385 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5386 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5387 for a UNIX socket).
5388
5389 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5390
5391 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5392
5393 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5394
5395 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5396
5397 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5398
5399 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5400 socket).
5401
5402 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5403 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5404
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005405 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5406 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5407 failed.
5408
5409 Example :
5410 external-check command /bin/true
5411
5412 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5413
5414
5415external-check path <path>
5416 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5418 yes | no | yes | yes
5419
5420 Arguments :
5421 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5422
5423 The default path is "".
5424
5425 Example :
5426 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5427
5428 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5429 "external-check command"
5430
5431
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005432persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005433persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005434 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 yes | no | yes | yes
5437 Arguments :
5438 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005439 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5440 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005441
5442 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5443 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5444 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5445 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5446 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5447 forwarded to this server.
5448
5449 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5450 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5451 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005452 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005453 a single "listen" section.
5454
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005455 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5456 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5457 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5458
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005459 Example :
5460 listen tse-farm
5461 bind :3389
5462 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5463 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5464 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5465 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5466 persist rdp-cookie
5467 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005468 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005469 balance rdp-cookie
5470 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5471 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5472
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005473 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5474 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005475
5476
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005477rate-limit sessions <rate>
5478 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5480 yes | yes | yes | no
5481 Arguments :
5482 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5483 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5484
5485 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5486 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5487 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5488 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5489 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5490 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5491
5492 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5493 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5494 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5495 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5496
5497 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5498 listen smtp
5499 mode tcp
5500 bind :25
5501 rate-limit sessions 10
5502 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5503
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005504 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5505 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5506 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005507
5508 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5509
5510
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005511redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5512redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5513redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005514 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5516 no | yes | yes | yes
5517
5518 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005519 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005520
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005521 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005522 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005523 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5524 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5525 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005526
5527 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5528 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5529 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5530 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5531 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005532 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5533 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5534 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5535 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005536
5537 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5538 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5539 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5540 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5541 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5542 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005543 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005544 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005545 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5546 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5547 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005548
5549 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005550 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5551 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5552 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5553 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5554 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5555 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5556 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5557 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005558
5559 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5560 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5561
5562 - "drop-query"
5563 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5564 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5565 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5566 with a location-type redirect.
5567
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005568 - "append-slash"
5569 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5570 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5571 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5572 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5573
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005574 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5575 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5576 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5577 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5578 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5579 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5580 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5581
5582 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5583 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5584 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5585 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5586 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5587 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5588 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005589
5590 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5591 acl clear dst_port 80
5592 acl secure dst_port 8080
5593 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005594 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005595 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005596 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5597
5598 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005599 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5600 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5601 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005602 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005603
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005604 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5605 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5606 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5607
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005608 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005609 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005610
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005611 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5612 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5613 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005615 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005616
5617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005618redisp (deprecated)
5619redispatch (deprecated)
5620 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005623 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005624
5625 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5626 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5627 be able to access the service anymore.
5628
5629 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5630 redistribute them to a working server.
5631
5632 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5633 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5634 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005636 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5637 "option redispatch" instead.
5638
5639 See also : "option redispatch"
5640
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005641
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005642reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005643 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 no | yes | yes | yes
5646 Arguments :
5647 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5648 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005649 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005650
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005651 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5652 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5653
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005654 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5655 the last header of an HTTP request.
5656
5657 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5658 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5659 responses.
5660
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005661 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5662 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5663 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5664
5665 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5666 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005667
5668
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005669reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5670reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005671 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 no | yes | yes | yes
5674 Arguments :
5675 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5676 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5677 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5678 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5679 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5680 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5681 ignores case.
5682
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005683 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5684 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5685
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005686 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5687 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5688 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5689 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005690 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005691
5692 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5693 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5694
5695 Example :
5696 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5697 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5698 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5699
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005700 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5701 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005702
5703
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005704reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5705reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005706 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 no | yes | yes | yes
5709 Arguments :
5710 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5711 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5712 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5713 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5714 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5715 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5716
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005717 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5718 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5719
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005720 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5721 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5722 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5723 next servers.
5724
5725 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5726 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5727 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5728
5729 Example :
5730 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5731 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5732 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5733
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005734 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5735 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005736
5737
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005738reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5739reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005740 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5742 no | yes | yes | yes
5743 Arguments :
5744 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5745 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5746 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5747 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5748 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5749 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5750 case.
5751
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005752 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5753 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5754
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005755 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5756 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5757 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5758 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005759 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005760
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005761 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005762 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005763 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005764
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005765 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5766 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5767
5768 Example :
5769 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5770 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5771 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5772
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005773 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5774 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005775
5776
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005777reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5778reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005779 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 no | yes | yes | yes
5782 Arguments :
5783 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5784 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5785 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5786 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5787 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5788 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5789 case.
5790
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005791 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5792 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5793
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005794 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5795 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5796 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5797 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5798
5799 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5800 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5801
5802 Example :
5803 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5804 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5805 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5806 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5807
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005808 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5809 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005810
5811
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005812reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5813reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005814 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5816 no | yes | yes | yes
5817 Arguments :
5818 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5819 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5820 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5821 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5822 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5823 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5824
5825 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5826 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5827 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5828 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005829 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005830
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005831 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5832 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5833
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005834 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5835 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5836 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5837
5838 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5839 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5840 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5841 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5842 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5843
5844 Example :
5845 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005846 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005847 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5848 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5849
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005850 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5851 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005852
5853
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005854reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5855reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005856 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 no | yes | yes | yes
5859 Arguments :
5860 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5861 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5862 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5863 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5864 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5865 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5866 ignores case.
5867
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005868 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5869 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5870
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005871 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5872 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005873 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5874 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5875 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005876 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5877 not set.
5878
5879 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5880 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5881 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5882 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5883 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5884
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005885 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005886 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5887 # block all others.
5888 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5889 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5890
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005891 # block bad guys
5892 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5893 reqitarpit . if badguys
5894
5895 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5896 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005897
5898
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005899retries <value>
5900 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5901 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5902 yes | no | yes | yes
5903 Arguments :
5904 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5905 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5906 default value is 3.
5907
5908 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5909 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5910 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5911
5912 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5913 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5914
5915 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5916 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5917
5918 See also : "option redispatch"
5919
5920
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005921rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005922 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5924 no | yes | yes | yes
5925 Arguments :
5926 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5927 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005928 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005929
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005930 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5931 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5932
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005933 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5934 the last header of an HTTP response.
5935
5936 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5937 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5938 responses.
5939
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005940 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5941 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005942
5943
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005944rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5945rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005946 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5948 no | yes | yes | yes
5949 Arguments :
5950 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5951 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5952 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5953 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5954 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5955 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5956 ignores case.
5957
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005958 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5959 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5960
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005961 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5962 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005963 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005964 client.
5965
5966 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5967 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5968 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5969
5970 Example :
5971 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005972 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005973
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005974 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5975 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005976
5977
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005978rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5979rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005980 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5982 no | yes | yes | yes
5983 Arguments :
5984 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5985 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5986 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5987 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5988 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5989 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5990 ignores case.
5991
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005992 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5993 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5994
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005995 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5996 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5997 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5998 case-sensitive.
5999
6000 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006001 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6002 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6003 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006004
6005 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6006 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6007
6008 Example :
6009 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6010 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6011
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006012 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6013 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006014
6015
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006016rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6017rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006018 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6020 no | yes | yes | yes
6021 Arguments :
6022 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6023 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6024 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6025 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6026 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6027 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6028 ignores case.
6029
6030 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6031 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6032 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6033 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006034 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006035
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006036 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6037 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6038
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006039 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6040 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6041 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6042
6043 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6044 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6045 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6046 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6047 are not case-sensitive.
6048
6049 Example :
6050 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6051 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6052
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006053 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6054 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006055
6056
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006057server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006058 Declare a server in a backend
6059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6060 no | no | yes | yes
6061 Arguments :
6062 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006063 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006064 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006065
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006066 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6067 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6068 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6069 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006070 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6071 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6072 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6073 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6074 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006075 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6076 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6077 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6078 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6079 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6080 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6081 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006082 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006083 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6084 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6085 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6086 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006087
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006088 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006089 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6090 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6091 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6092 adding this value to the client's port.
6093
6094 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6095 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006096 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006097
6098 Examples :
6099 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6100 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006101 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006102 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6103 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6104 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006105
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006106 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6107 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006108
6109
6110source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006111source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006112source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006113 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6115 yes | no | yes | yes
6116 Arguments :
6117 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6118 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006119
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006120 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006121 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6122 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6123 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6124 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6125 supported prefixes are :
6126 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6127 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6128 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006129 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006130 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6131 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6132 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6133 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006134
6135 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6136 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006137 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6138 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6139 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006140
6141 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6142 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6143 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6144 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6145 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6146 <addr>.
6147
6148 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6149 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6150 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6151 port.
6152
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006153 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6154 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6155 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6156 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006157 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006158 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6159 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6160 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6161 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6162 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6163 HTTP header.
6164
6165 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6166 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006167 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006168 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6169 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6170 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6171 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6172 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6173 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6174 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6175
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006176 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6177 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6178 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6179 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6180 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6181 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6182
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006183 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6184 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6185 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6186 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6187
6188 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6189 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6190 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6191 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6192 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6193 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6194
6195 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6196 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6197 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6198 there are two methods :
6199
6200 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6201 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6202 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6203 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6204 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6205 of the client ranges may be used.
6206
6207 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6208 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6209 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6210 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6211 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6212 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6213 same session.
6214
6215 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6216 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6217 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6218 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6219 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6220 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6221
6222 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6223 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6224 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006225 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006226
6227 Examples :
6228 backend private
6229 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6230 source 192.168.1.200
6231
6232 backend transparent_ssl1
6233 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6234 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6235
6236 backend transparent_ssl2
6237 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6238 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6239 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6240
6241 backend transparent_ssl3
6242 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6243 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6244 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6245
6246 backend transparent_smtp
6247 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6248 # with Tproxy version 4.
6249 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6250
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006251 backend transparent_http
6252 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6253 # proxy.
6254 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006256 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006257 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006259
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006260srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6261 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6263 yes | no | yes | yes
6264 Arguments :
6265 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6266 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6267 as explained at the top of this document.
6268
6269 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6270 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6271 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6272 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6273 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6274 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6275 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6276
6277 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6278 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6279 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6280 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6281 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006282 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006283 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006284 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006285
6286 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6287 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6288 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6289 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6290 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6291 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6292
6293 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6294 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6295
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006296 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6297 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006298
6299
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006300stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6301 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006303 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006304
6305 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6306 matched.
6307
6308 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6309 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6310
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006311 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6312 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6313 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6314
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006315 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6316 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6317 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6318 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006319
6320 Example :
6321 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6322 backend stats_localhost
6323 stats enable
6324 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6325
6326 Example :
6327 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6328 backend stats_auth
6329 stats enable
6330 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6331 stats admin if TRUE
6332
6333 Example :
6334 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6335 userlist stats-auth
6336 group admin users admin
6337 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6338 group readonly users haproxy
6339 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6340
6341 backend stats_auth
6342 stats enable
6343 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6344 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6345 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6346 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6347
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006348 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6349 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6350 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006351
6352
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006353stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6354 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006357 Arguments :
6358 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6359
6360 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6361
6362 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6363 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6364 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6365 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6366 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6367 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6368
6369 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6370 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6371 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006372 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006373
6374 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6375 report using "stats scope".
6376
6377 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6378 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6379 unobvious parameters.
6380
6381 Example :
6382 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6383 backend public_www
6384 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6385 stats enable
6386 stats hide-version
6387 stats scope .
6388 stats uri /admin?stats
6389 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6390 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6391 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6392
6393 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6394 backend private_monitoring
6395 stats enable
6396 stats uri /admin?stats
6397 stats refresh 5s
6398
6399 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6400
6401
6402stats enable
6403 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006405 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006406 Arguments : none
6407
6408 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6409 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6410 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6411 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6412 - stats auth : no authentication
6413 - stats scope : no restriction
6414
6415 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6416 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6417 unobvious parameters.
6418
6419 Example :
6420 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6421 backend public_www
6422 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6423 stats enable
6424 stats hide-version
6425 stats scope .
6426 stats uri /admin?stats
6427 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6428 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6429 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6430
6431 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6432 backend private_monitoring
6433 stats enable
6434 stats uri /admin?stats
6435 stats refresh 5s
6436
6437 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6438
6439
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006440stats hide-version
6441 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006443 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006444 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006445
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006446 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6447 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6448 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6449 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6450 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6451 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006453 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6454 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6455 unobvious parameters.
6456
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006457 Example :
6458 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6459 backend public_www
6460 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006461 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006462 stats hide-version
6463 stats scope .
6464 stats uri /admin?stats
6465 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6466 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6467 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006468
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006469 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6470 backend private_monitoring
6471 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006472 stats uri /admin?stats
6473 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006474
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006475 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006476
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006477
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006478stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6479 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6480 Access control for statistics
6481
6482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 no | no | yes | yes
6484
6485 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6486 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6487 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6488 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6489 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6490 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6491
6492 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6493 instance.
6494
6495 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6496 about ACL usage.
6497
6498
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006499stats realm <realm>
6500 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006502 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006503 Arguments :
6504 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6505 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6506 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6507
6508 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6509 using a backslash ('\').
6510
6511 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6512 only related to authentication.
6513
6514 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6515 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6516 unobvious parameters.
6517
6518 Example :
6519 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6520 backend public_www
6521 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6522 stats enable
6523 stats hide-version
6524 stats scope .
6525 stats uri /admin?stats
6526 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6527 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6528 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6529
6530 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6531 backend private_monitoring
6532 stats enable
6533 stats uri /admin?stats
6534 stats refresh 5s
6535
6536 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6537
6538
6539stats refresh <delay>
6540 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006542 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006543 Arguments :
6544 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6545 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6546 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6547 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6548 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6549 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6550
6551 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6552 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6553 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6554 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6555
6556 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6557 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6558 unobvious parameters.
6559
6560 Example :
6561 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6562 backend public_www
6563 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6564 stats enable
6565 stats hide-version
6566 stats scope .
6567 stats uri /admin?stats
6568 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6569 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6570 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6571
6572 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6573 backend private_monitoring
6574 stats enable
6575 stats uri /admin?stats
6576 stats refresh 5s
6577
6578 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6579
6580
6581stats scope { <name> | "." }
6582 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006584 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006585 Arguments :
6586 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6587 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6588 section in which the statement appears.
6589
6590 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6591 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6592 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6593 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6594 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6595 exists.
6596
6597 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6598 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6599 unobvious parameters.
6600
6601 Example :
6602 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6603 backend public_www
6604 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6605 stats enable
6606 stats hide-version
6607 stats scope .
6608 stats uri /admin?stats
6609 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6610 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6611 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6612
6613 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6614 backend private_monitoring
6615 stats enable
6616 stats uri /admin?stats
6617 stats refresh 5s
6618
6619 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6620
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006621
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006622stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006623 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006625 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006626
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006627 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006628 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6629
6630 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6631 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6632
6633 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6634 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006635 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006636
6637 Example :
6638 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6639 backend private_monitoring
6640 stats enable
6641 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6642 stats uri /admin?stats
6643 stats refresh 5s
6644
6645 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6646 global section.
6647
6648
6649stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006650 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6652 yes | yes | yes | yes
6653 Arguments : none
6654
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006655 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006656 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6657 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6658 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6659 - IP (socket, server)
6660 - cookie (backend, server)
6661
6662 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6663 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006664 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006665
6666 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6667
6668
6669stats show-node [ <name> ]
6670 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006672 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006673 Arguments:
6674 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6675 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6676
6677 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6678 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006679 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006680
6681 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6682 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6683 unobvious parameters.
6684
6685 Example:
6686 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6687 backend private_monitoring
6688 stats enable
6689 stats show-node Europe-1
6690 stats uri /admin?stats
6691 stats refresh 5s
6692
6693 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6694 section.
6695
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006696
6697stats uri <prefix>
6698 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006700 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006701 Arguments :
6702 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6703 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6704 query string.
6705
6706 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6707 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6708 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6709 possible to reach it in the application.
6710
6711 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006712 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006713 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6714 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6715 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6716 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6717
6718 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6719 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6720 an address or a port to statistics only.
6721
6722 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6723 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6724 unobvious parameters.
6725
6726 Example :
6727 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6728 backend public_www
6729 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6730 stats enable
6731 stats hide-version
6732 stats scope .
6733 stats uri /admin?stats
6734 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6735 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6736 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6737
6738 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6739 backend private_monitoring
6740 stats enable
6741 stats uri /admin?stats
6742 stats refresh 5s
6743
6744 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6745
6746
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006747stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6748 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006750 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006751
6752 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006753 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006754 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6755 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6756 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6757
6758 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6759 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6760 the "stick-table" statement.
6761
6762 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6763 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6764 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6765 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6766 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6767
6768 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6769 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6770 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6771 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6772 transformation rules.
6773
6774 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6775 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6776 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6777 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6778 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6779 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6780 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6781
6782 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6783 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6784 ACL based conditions.
6785
6786 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6787 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6788 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6789 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6790
6791 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6792 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6793 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6794 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6795
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006796 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6797 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6798 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6799
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006800 Example :
6801 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6802 # last 30 minutes
6803 backend pop
6804 mode tcp
6805 balance roundrobin
6806 stick store-request src
6807 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6808 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6809 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6810
6811 backend smtp
6812 mode tcp
6813 balance roundrobin
6814 stick match src table pop
6815 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6816 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6817
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006818 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006819 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006820
6821
6822stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6823 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6825 no | no | yes | yes
6826
6827 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6828 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6829 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6830 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6831
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006832 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6833 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6834 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6835
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006836 Examples :
6837 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006838 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006839
6840 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6841 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6842 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6843
6844
6845 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6846 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6847 backend http
6848 mode http
6849 balance roundrobin
6850 stick on src table https
6851 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6852 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6853 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6854
6855 backend https
6856 mode tcp
6857 balance roundrobin
6858 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6859 stick on src
6860 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6861 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6862
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006863 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006864
6865
6866stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6867 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6869 no | no | yes | yes
6870
6871 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006872 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006873 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6874 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6875 server is selected.
6876
6877 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6878 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6879 the "stick-table" statement.
6880
6881 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6882 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6883 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6884 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6885 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6886 address.
6887
6888 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6889 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6890 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6891 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6892 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6893 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6894 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6895 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6896 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6897 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6898
6899 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6900 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6901 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6902 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6903 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6904 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6905 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6906
6907 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6908 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6909 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6910 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6911
6912 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6913 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6914 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6915 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6916 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6917 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006918 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6919 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6920 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6921 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6922 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6923 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006924
6925 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6926 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6927 the request.
6928
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006929 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6930 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6931 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6932
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006933 Example :
6934 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6935 # last 30 minutes
6936 backend pop
6937 mode tcp
6938 balance roundrobin
6939 stick store-request src
6940 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6941 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6942 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6943
6944 backend smtp
6945 mode tcp
6946 balance roundrobin
6947 stick match src table pop
6948 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6949 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6950
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006951 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006952 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006953
6954
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006955stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006956 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6957 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006958 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006960 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006961
6962 Arguments :
6963 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6964 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6965 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6966 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6967
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006968 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6969 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6970 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6971 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6972
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006973 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6974 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6975 instance.
6976
6977 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6978 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6979 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6980 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6981 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6982 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006983 to 32 characters.
6984
6985 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6986 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6987 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006988 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006989 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6990 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006991
6992 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006993 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6994 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006995 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6996 increase.
6997
6998 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006999 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7000 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7001 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007002
7003 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7004 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7005 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7006 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7007 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7008 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7009 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7010 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7011 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7012 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7013 parameter (see below).
7014
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007015 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7016 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7017 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7018 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7019 soft restart.
7020
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007021 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
7022
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007023 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7024 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7025 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7026 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7027 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007028 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007029 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7030 if not expiration delay is specified.
7031
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007032 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7033 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7034 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7035 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007036 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7037 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7038 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7039 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7040 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7041 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7042 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7043 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7044 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7045 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7046 types and their arguments.
7047
7048 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7049 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7050 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7051 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7052
7053 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7054 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7055 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7056 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7057
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007058 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7059 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7060 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7061 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7062 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7063 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7064
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007065 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7066 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7067 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7068 they were received.
7069
7070 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7071 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7072 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7073 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7074 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7075
7076 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7077 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7078 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7079 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7080 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7081
7082 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7083 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7084 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7085
7086 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7087 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7088 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7089 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7090 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7091
7092 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7093 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7094 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7095 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7096 the client side.
7097
7098 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7099 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7100 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7101 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7102 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7103 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7104 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7105
7106 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7107 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7108 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7109 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7110 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7111 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7112 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7113
7114 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7115 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7116 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7117 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7118 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7119 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7120
7121 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7122 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7123 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7124 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7125
7126 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7127 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7128 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7129 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7130 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7131 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7132 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7133 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7134 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7135 recommended for better fairness.
7136
7137 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7138 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7139 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7140 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7141
7142 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7143 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7144 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7145 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7146 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7147 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7148 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7149 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7150 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7151 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007152
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007153 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7154 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007155 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7156 reference it.
7157
7158 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7159 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7160 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7161 as an exclusive stickiness.
7162
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007163 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7164 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7165 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7166 something that can be ignored.
7167
7168 Example:
7169 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7170 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7171 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7172 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7173
7174 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007175 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007176
7177
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007178stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7179 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7181 no | no | yes | yes
7182
7183 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007184 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007185 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7186 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7187 server is selected.
7188
7189 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7190 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7191 the "stick-table" statement.
7192
7193 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7194 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7195 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7196 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7197
7198 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7199 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7200 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7201 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7202 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7203 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007204 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007205 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7206 rules.
7207
7208 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7209 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7210 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7211 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7212 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7213 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7214 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7215
7216 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7217 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7218 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7219 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7220
7221 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7222 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7223 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7224 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7225 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7226 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007227 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7228 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7229 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7230 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7231 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7232 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7233 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7234 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7235 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007236
7237 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7238
7239 Example :
7240 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7241 backend https
7242 mode tcp
7243 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007244 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007245 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007246
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007247 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7248 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7249
7250 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7251 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7252 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7253
7254 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7255 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007256
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007257 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7258 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7259 # at offset 44.
7260
7261 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7262 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7263
7264 # Learn on response if server hello.
7265 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007266
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007267 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7268 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7269
7270 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7271 extraction.
7272
7273
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007274tcp-check connect [params*]
7275 Opens a new connection
7276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7277 no | no | yes | yes
7278
7279 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7280 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7281 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7282
7283 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7284 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7285 of the sequence.
7286
7287 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7288 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7289 do.
7290
7291 Parameters :
7292 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7293 use the TCP connection.
7294
7295 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7296 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7297 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7298
7299 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7300
7301 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7302
7303 Examples:
7304 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7305 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7306 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7307 option tcp-check
7308 tcp-check connect
7309 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7310 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7311 tcp-check send \r\n
7312 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7313 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7314 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7315 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7316 tcp-check send \r\n
7317 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7318 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7319
7320 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7321 option tcp-check
7322 tcp-check connect port 110
7323 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7324 tcp-check connect port 143
7325 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7326 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7327
7328 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7329
7330
7331tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7332 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7334 no | no | yes | yes
7335
7336 Arguments :
7337 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7338 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7339 binary.
7340 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7341 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7342 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7343
7344 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7345 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7346 with the usual backslash ('\').
7347 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7348 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7349 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7350 used upper or lower case.
7351
7352
7353 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7354
7355 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7356 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7357 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7358 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7359 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7360 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7361 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7362 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7363
7364 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7365 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7366 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7367 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7368 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7369 expression.
7370
7371 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7372 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7373 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7374 this exact hexadecimal string.
7375 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7376
7377 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7378 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7379 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7380 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7381 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7382 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7383 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7384 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7385 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7386 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7387 the null character.
7388
7389 Examples :
7390 # perform a POP check
7391 option tcp-check
7392 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7393
7394 # perform an IMAP check
7395 option tcp-check
7396 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7397
7398 # look for the redis master server
7399 option tcp-check
7400 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7401 tcp-check expect +PONG
7402 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7403 tcp-check expect string role:master
7404 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7405 tcp-check expect string +OK
7406
7407
7408 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7409 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7410
7411
7412tcp-check send <data>
7413 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7414 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7415 no | no | yes | yes
7416
7417 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7418 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7419
7420 Examples :
7421 # look for the redis master server
7422 option tcp-check
7423 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7424 tcp-check expect string role:master
7425
7426 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7427 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7428
7429
7430tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7431 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7432 tcp health check
7433 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7434 no | no | yes | yes
7435
7436 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7437 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7438 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7439 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7440 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7441 hexadecimal string.
7442 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7443
7444 Examples :
7445 # redis check in binary
7446 option tcp-check
7447 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7448 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7449
7450
7451 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7452 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7453
7454
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007455tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7456 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7458 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007459 Arguments :
7460 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007461 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7462 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007463
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007464 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007465
7466 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7467 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007468 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7469 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7470 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7471 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7472 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7473 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007475 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7476 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7477 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7478 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007479
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007480 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007481 - accept :
7482 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7483 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7484 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007485
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007486 - reject :
7487 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7488 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7489 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7490 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7491 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7492 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7493 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7494 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7495 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7496 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7497 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7498 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007499
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007500 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7501 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7502 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7503 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7504 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7505 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7506 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7507 hosts.
7508
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007509 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7510 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7511 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7512 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7513 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7514 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7515 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7516 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7517 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7518 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7519 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7520
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007521 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007522 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007523 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007524 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007525 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7526 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007527 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007528 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7529 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7530 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7531 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7532 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007534 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007535 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007536 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007537 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7538 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7539 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7540 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007541
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007542 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7543 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7544 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7545 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007546
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007547 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7548 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7549 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7550 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7551 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007552 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7553 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7554 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7555 layer7 information is extracted.
7556
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007557 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7558 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7559 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7560 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7561 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007562
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007563 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7564 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7565 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007567 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7568 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7569 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007571 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007572 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007573 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007574
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007575 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7576 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7577 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007579 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007580 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7581 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007582
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007583 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7584
7585 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7586
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007587 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007589 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007590
7591
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007592tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7593 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007595 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007596 Arguments :
7597 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007598 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007599 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7600 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007602 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007604 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7605 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7606 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7607 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7608 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007609
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007610 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7611 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7612 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7613 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007614 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7615 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7616 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7617 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7618 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7619 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007620 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007621 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007622
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007623 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7624 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7625 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7626 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007627
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007628 Four types of actions are supported :
7629 - accept : the request is accepted
7630 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7631 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007632 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007633
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007634 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7635 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007636
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007637 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7638 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7639 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7640 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7641 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7642 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007644 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007645 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7646 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007647
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007648 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007649 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7650 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7651 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7652 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007653 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7654 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7655 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007656
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007657 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007658 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7659 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7660 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007661
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007662 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007663 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7664 # and reject everything else.
7665 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7666 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007667 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007668 tcp-request content reject
7669
7670 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007671 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7672 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7673 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007674 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007675
7676 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7677 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7678 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007679 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007680 tcp-request content reject
7681
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007682 Example:
7683 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7684 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007685 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007686
7687 Example:
7688 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7689 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007690 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007691
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007692 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7693 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7694
7695 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007696 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007697 # protecting all our sites
7698 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007699 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7700 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007701 ...
7702 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7703
7704 backend http_dynamic
7705 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007706 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007707 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007708 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7709 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7710 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007711 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007713 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007714
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007715 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007716
7717
7718tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7719 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007721 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007722 Arguments :
7723 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7725 as explained at the top of this document.
7726
7727 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7728 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7729 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7730 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7731 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7732
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007733 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7734 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7735 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7736 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7737
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007738 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7739 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007740 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007741 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007742 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7743 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7744 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7745 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007746
7747 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7748 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7749 it pass through unaffected.
7750
7751 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7752 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7753 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007754 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007755 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7756 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007757 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7758 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7759 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007760
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007761 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007762 "timeout client".
7763
7764
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007765tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7766 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7768 no | no | yes | yes
7769 Arguments :
7770 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007771 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007772
7773 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7774
7775 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7776 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7777 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007778 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7779 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007780
7781 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7782
7783 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7784 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7785 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7786 inserted.
7787
7788 Two types of actions are supported :
7789 - accept :
7790 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7791 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7792 the rules evaluation.
7793
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007794 - close :
7795 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7796 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7797 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7798 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7799 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7800 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007801 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007802 protocols.
7803
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007804 - reject :
7805 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7806 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007807 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007808
7809 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7810 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7811 for changing the default action to a reject.
7812
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007813 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7814 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7815 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7816 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007817 period.
7818
7819 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7820
7821 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7822
7823
7824tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7825 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7827 no | no | yes | yes
7828 Arguments :
7829 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7830 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7831 as explained at the top of this document.
7832
7833 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7834
7835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007836timeout check <timeout>
7837 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7838 established.
7839
7840 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7841 yes | no | yes | yes
7842 Arguments:
7843 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7844 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7845 as explained at the top of this document.
7846
7847 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7848 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7849 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7850 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007851 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7852 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7853 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007854
7855 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7856 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7857
7858 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7859 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007860 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007861
7862 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7863 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7864 forget about it.
7865
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007866 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7867 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007868
7869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007870timeout client <timeout>
7871timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7872 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7874 yes | yes | yes | no
7875 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007876 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007877 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7878 as explained at the top of this document.
7879
7880 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7881 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7882 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7883 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7884 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7885 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7886 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7887 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007888 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007889 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007890 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7891 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007892 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7893 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007894
7895 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7896 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7897 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7898 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7899 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7900 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7901
7902 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7903 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7904 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7905
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007906 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007907
7908
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007909timeout client-fin <timeout>
7910 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7912 yes | yes | yes | no
7913 Arguments :
7914 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7915 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7916 as explained at the top of this document.
7917
7918 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7919 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7920 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7921 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7922 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7923 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7924 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7925 down in one direction.
7926
7927 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7928 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7929 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7930
7931 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7932
7933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007934timeout connect <timeout>
7935timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7936 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 yes | no | yes | yes
7939 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007940 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007941 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7942 as explained at the top of this document.
7943
7944 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007945 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007946 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007947 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007948 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7949 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007950
7951 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7952 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7953 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7954 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7955 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7956 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7957
7958 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7959 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7960 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7961
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007962 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7963 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007964
7965
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007966timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7967 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7969 yes | yes | yes | yes
7970 Arguments :
7971 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7972 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7973 as explained at the top of this document.
7974
7975 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7976 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7977 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7978 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7979 once the request has started to present itself.
7980
7981 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7982 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7983 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7984 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7985 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7986
7987 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7988 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7989 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7990 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7991
7992 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7993 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7994 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7995 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7996 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007997 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007998
7999 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8000 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8001 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8002 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8003
8004 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8005
8006
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008007timeout http-request <timeout>
8008 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008010 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008011 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008012 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008013 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8014 as explained at the top of this document.
8015
8016 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8017 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8018 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8019 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8020 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8021 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8022 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008023 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8024 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8025 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8026 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8027 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
8028 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
8029 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008030
8031 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8032 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008033 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8034 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008035
8036 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8037 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8038 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8039 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8040 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8041
8042 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008043 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8044 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8045 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008046
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008047 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008048
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008049
8050timeout queue <timeout>
8051 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | no | yes | yes
8054 Arguments :
8055 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8056 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8057 as explained at the top of this document.
8058
8059 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8060 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8061 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8062 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8063 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8064
8065 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8066 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8067 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8068 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8069
8070 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8071
8072
8073timeout server <timeout>
8074timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8075 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8077 yes | no | yes | yes
8078 Arguments :
8079 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8080 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8081 as explained at the top of this document.
8082
8083 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8084 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8085 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8086 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8087 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8088 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8089 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8090
8091 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8092 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8093 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8094 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8095 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008096 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008097 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008098 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8099 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8100 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8101 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008102
8103 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8104 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8105 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8106 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8107 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8108 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8109
8110 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8111 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8112 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8113
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008114 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008115
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008116
8117timeout server-fin <timeout>
8118 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8120 yes | no | yes | yes
8121 Arguments :
8122 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8124 as explained at the top of this document.
8125
8126 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8127 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8128 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8129 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8130 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8131 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8132 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8133 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8134 situations, it should not be needed.
8135
8136 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8137 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8138 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8139
8140 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8141
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008142
8143timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008144 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8146 yes | yes | yes | yes
8147 Arguments :
8148 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8150 as explained at the top of this document.
8151
8152 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8153 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8154 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8155
8156 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8157 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8158 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8159 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008160 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008161
8162 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8163
8164
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008165timeout tunnel <timeout>
8166 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8168 yes | no | yes | yes
8169 Arguments :
8170 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8171 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8172 as explained at the top of this document.
8173
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008174 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008175 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8176 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8177 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8178 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8179 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8180 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8181 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8182 specified.
8183
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008184 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8185 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8186 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8187 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8188 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8189 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8190 state.
8191
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008192 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8193 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8194 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8195 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8196 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8197
8198 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8199 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8200 forget about it.
8201
8202 Example :
8203 defaults http
8204 option http-server-close
8205 timeout connect 5s
8206 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008207 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008208 timeout server 30s
8209 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8210
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008211 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008212
8213
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008214transparent (deprecated)
8215 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008217 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008218 Arguments : none
8219
8220 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8221 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8222 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8223 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8224 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8225 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8226 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8227 appropriate server.
8228
8229 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8230
8231 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8232 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8233
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008234 See also: "option transparent"
8235
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008236unique-id-format <string>
8237 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8239 yes | yes | yes | no
8240 Arguments :
8241 <string> is a log-format string.
8242
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008243 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8244 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8245 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8246 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008247
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008248 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8249 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8250 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8251 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8252 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8253 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8254 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8255 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008256
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008257 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8258 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008259
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008260 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008261
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008262 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008263
8264 will generate:
8265
8266 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8267
8268 See also: "unique-id-header"
8269
8270unique-id-header <name>
8271 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8273 yes | yes | yes | no
8274 Arguments :
8275 <name> is the name of the header.
8276
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008277 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8278 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008279
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008280 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008281
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008282 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008283 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8284
8285 will generate:
8286
8287 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8288
8289 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008290
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008291use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008292 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8294 no | yes | yes | no
8295 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008296 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8297 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008298
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008299 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8300 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008301
8302 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8303 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8304 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008305 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8306 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8307 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8308 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008309
8310 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8311 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8312 assign the backend.
8313
8314 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8315 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8316 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8317 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8318 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8319 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8320
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008321 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008322 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008323 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8324 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8325 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8326
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008327 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8328 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8329 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8330 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8331 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8332 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8333 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8334 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8335 cannot be forced from the request.
8336
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008337 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008338 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8339 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8340
8341 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8342 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008343
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008344
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008345use-server <server> if <condition>
8346use-server <server> unless <condition>
8347 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8349 no | no | yes | yes
8350 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008351 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008352
8353 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8354
8355 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8356 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8357 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8358
8359 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8360 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8361 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8362 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8363 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8364 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8365 matches will assign the server.
8366
8367 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8368 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8369 with the next rules until one matches.
8370
8371 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8372 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8373 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8374 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8375
8376 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8377 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8378 stripped.
8379
8380 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8381 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8382 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8383 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8384
8385 Example :
8386 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8387 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8388 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8389 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8390 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8391 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8392 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8393 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8394 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8395
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008396 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008397
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008398
83995. Bind and Server options
8400--------------------------
8401
8402The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8403depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8404settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8405written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8406described in this section.
8407
8408
84095.1. Bind options
8410-----------------
8411
8412The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8413as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8414no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8415parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8416while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8417provided immediately after the setting name.
8418
8419The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8420
8421accept-proxy
8422 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008423 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8424 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008425 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8426 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8427 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8428 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8429 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8430 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8431 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008432 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8433 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008434
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008435alpn <protocols>
8436 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8437 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8438 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8439 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8440 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8441 initial NPN extension.
8442
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008443backlog <backlog>
8444 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8445 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8446
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008447ecdhe <named curve>
8448 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008449 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8450 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008451
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008452ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8454 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8455 client's certificate.
8456
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008457ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8459 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8460 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8461 error is ignored.
8462
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008463ciphers <ciphers>
8464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8465 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008466 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008467 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8468 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8469
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008470crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8472 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8473 to verify client's certificate.
8474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008475crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8477 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8478 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8479 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8480 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8481 file.
8482
8483 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8484 are loaded.
8485
8486 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008487 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8488 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008489 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8490 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8491 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8492 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8493 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8494 www.sub.example.org).
8495
8496 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8497 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8498 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8499 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8500 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8501
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008502 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008503
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008504 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8505 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008506 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008507 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8508 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8509 clients).
8510
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008511 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8512 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8513 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8514 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8515 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8516 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8517 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8518 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8519 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8520 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8521 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8522 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8523 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8524
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008525crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008526 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8527 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008528 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008529 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008530
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008531crt-list <file>
8532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008533 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8534 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008535
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008536 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008537
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008538 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8539 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8540 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8541 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8542 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8543 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8544 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8545 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008546
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008547defer-accept
8548 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8549 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8550 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8551 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8552 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8553 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8554 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8555 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8556 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8557 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8558 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8559
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008560force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008561 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008562 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008563 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8564 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008565
8566force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008567 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008568 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8569 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008570
8571force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008572 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008573 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8574 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008575
8576force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008577 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008578 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8579 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008580
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008581gid <gid>
8582 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8583 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8584 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8585 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8586 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8587
8588group <group>
8589 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8590 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8591 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8592 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8593 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8594
8595id <id>
8596 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8597 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8598 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8599 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8600
8601interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008602 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8603 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8604 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8605 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8606 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8607 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8608 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008609
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008610level <level>
8611 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8612 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8613 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8614 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8615 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8616 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8617 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8618 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8619 counters).
8620 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8621 all counters).
8622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008623maxconn <maxconn>
8624 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8625 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8626 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8627 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8628 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8629 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8630 eat all memory.
8631
8632mode <mode>
8633 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8634 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8635 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8636 UNIX sockets.
8637
8638mss <maxseg>
8639 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8640 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8641 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8642 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8643 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8644 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8645 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8646 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8647 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8648 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8649 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8650
8651name <name>
8652 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8653 page.
8654
8655nice <nice>
8656 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8657 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8658 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8659 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8660 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8661 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8662 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8663 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8664 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8665 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8666 one for an RDP socket.
8667
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008668no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008670 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008671 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008672 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8673 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008674 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008675
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008676no-tls-tickets
8677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8678 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8679 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008680 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8681 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008682
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008683no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008685 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008686 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008687 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8688 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8689 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008690
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008691no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008692 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008693 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008694 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008695 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8696 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8697 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008698
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008699no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008700 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008701 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008702 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008703 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8704 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8705 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008706
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008707npn <protocols>
8708 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8709 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8710 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8711 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008712 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8713 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008714
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008715process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8716 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8717 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8718 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8719 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8720 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8721 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8722 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008723 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8724 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8725 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8726 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8727 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8728 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8729 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008730
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008731ssl
8732 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008733 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008734 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8735 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8736 to deciphered contents.
8737
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008738strict-sni
8739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8740 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8741 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8742 See the "crt" option for more information.
8743
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008744tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008745 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008746 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8747 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8748 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8749 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8750 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8751 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8752 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008753 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8754 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8755 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008756
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008757transparent
8758 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8759 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8760 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8761 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8762 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8763 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8764 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8765 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8766 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8767 so check for support with your vendor.
8768
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008769v4v6
8770 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8771 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8772 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8773 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008774 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008775
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008776v6only
8777 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8778 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8779 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008780 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8781 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008783uid <uid>
8784 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8785 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8786 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8787 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8788 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8789
8790user <user>
8791 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8792 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8793 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8794 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8795 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8796
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008797verify [none|optional|required]
8798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8799 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8800 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8801 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8802 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008803 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8804 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8805 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8806 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008807
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020088085.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008809------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008811The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8812which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8813arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8814settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8815after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8816Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8817address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008819 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008820 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008822The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008823
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008824addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008825 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8826 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8827 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8828 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8829 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008831 Supported in default-server: No
8832
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008833agent-check
8834 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008835 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8836 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8837 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8838 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008839
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008840 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008841 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008842 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8843 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8844 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008845
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008846 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8847 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008848
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008849 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8850 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8851 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008852
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008853 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8854 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8855 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008856
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008857 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8858 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8859 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8860 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8861 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8862 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8863 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008864
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008865 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8866 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008867
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008868 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8869 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8870 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8871 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8872 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8873 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8874 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8875 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8876 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008877
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008878 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8879 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008880 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8881 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8882 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8883 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008884
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008885 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8886 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008887
8888 Supported in default-server: No
8889
8890agent-inter <delay>
8891 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8892 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8893
8894 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8895 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8896 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8897 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8898 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8899 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8900 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8901 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8902 of backends use the same servers.
8903
8904 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8905
8906 Supported in default-server: Yes
8907
8908agent-port <port>
8909 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8910
8911 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8912
8913 Supported in default-server: Yes
8914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008915backup
8916 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8917 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8918 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8919 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8920 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8921 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008923 Supported in default-server: No
8924
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008925ca-file <cafile>
8926 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8927 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8928 server's certificate.
8929
8930 Supported in default-server: No
8931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008932check
8933 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008934 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8935 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8936 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8937 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8938 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8939 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8940 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008941 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8942 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8943 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008945 Supported in default-server: No
8946
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008947check-send-proxy
8948 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8949 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8950 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8951 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8952 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8953 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8954 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8955
8956 Supported in default-server: No
8957
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008958check-ssl
8959 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8960 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8961 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8962 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008963 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008964 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8965 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8966 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8967 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8968
8969 Supported in default-server: No
8970
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008971ciphers <ciphers>
8972 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008973 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008974 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8975 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8976 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8977 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8978 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8979 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8980
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008981 Supported in default-server: No
8982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008983cookie <value>
8984 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8985 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8986 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8987 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8988 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8989 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8990 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008992 Supported in default-server: No
8993
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008994crl-file <crlfile>
8995 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8996 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8997 to verify server's certificate.
8998
8999 Supported in default-server: No
9000
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009001crt <cert>
9002 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9003 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9004 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9005 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9006 certificate request.
9007
9008 Supported in default-server: No
9009
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009010disabled
9011 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9012 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9013 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9014 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9015 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9016
9017 Supported in default-server: No
9018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009019error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009020 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9021 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9022 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009024 Supported in default-server: Yes
9025
9026 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009028fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009029 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9030 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9031 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9032
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009033 Supported in default-server: Yes
9034
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009035force-sslv3
9036 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9037 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009038 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9039 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009040
9041 Supported in default-server: No
9042
9043force-tlsv10
9044 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009045 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9046 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009047
9048 Supported in default-server: No
9049
9050force-tlsv11
9051 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009052 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9053 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009054
9055 Supported in default-server: No
9056
9057force-tlsv12
9058 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009059 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9060 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009061
9062 Supported in default-server: No
9063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009064id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009065 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9066 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9067 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009069 Supported in default-server: No
9070
9071inter <delay>
9072fastinter <delay>
9073downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009074 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9075 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9076 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9077 between checks depending on the server state :
9078
9079 Server state | Interval used
9080 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9081 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9082 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9083 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9084 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9085 or yet unchecked. |
9086 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9087 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9088 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009090 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9091 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9092 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9093 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009094 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9095 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9096 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9097 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9098 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009100 Supported in default-server: Yes
9101
9102maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009103 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9104 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9105 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9106 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9107 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9108 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9109 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9110 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009112 Supported in default-server: Yes
9113
9114maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009115 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9116 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9117 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9118 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9119 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9120 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9121 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009123 Supported in default-server: Yes
9124
9125minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009126 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9127 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9128 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9129 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9130 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9131 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009132 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009133 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009135 Supported in default-server: Yes
9136
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009137no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009138 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9139 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009140 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009141
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009142 Supported in default-server: No
9143
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009144no-tls-tickets
9145 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9146 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9147 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009148 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9149 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009150
9151 Supported in default-server: No
9152
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009153no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009154 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009155 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9156 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009157 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9158 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9159 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009160
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009161 Supported in default-server: No
9162
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009163no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009164 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009165 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9166 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009167 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9168 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9169 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009170
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009171 Supported in default-server: No
9172
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009173no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009174 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009175 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9176 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009177 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9178 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9179 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009180
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009181 Supported in default-server: No
9182
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009183non-stick
9184 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9185 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9186 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9187
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009188 Supported in default-server: No
9189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009190observe <mode>
9191 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9192 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9193 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9194 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9195 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9196 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009197 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009199 Supported in default-server: No
9200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009201 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009203on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009204 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9205 Currently, four modes are available:
9206 - fastinter: force fastinter
9207 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9208 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9209 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9210 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009212 Supported in default-server: Yes
9213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009214 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9215
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009216on-marked-down <action>
9217 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9218 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009219 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9220 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9221 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9222 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9223 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9224 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9225 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9226 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009227
9228 Actions are disabled by default
9229
9230 Supported in default-server: Yes
9231
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009232on-marked-up <action>
9233 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9234 Currently one action is available:
9235 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9236 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9237 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9238 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9239 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9240 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9241 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9242 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9243
9244 Actions are disabled by default
9245
9246 Supported in default-server: Yes
9247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009248port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009249 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9250 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9251 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9252 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9253 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9254 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009256 Supported in default-server: Yes
9257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009258redir <prefix>
9259 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9260 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9261 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9262 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9263 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9264 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9265 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9266 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009267 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009268 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9269 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9270 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9271 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9272 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9273
9274 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009276 Supported in default-server: No
9277
9278rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009279 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9280 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9281 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009283 Supported in default-server: Yes
9284
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009285send-proxy
9286 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9287 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9288 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9289 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9290 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9291 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9292 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9293 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9294 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009295 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9296 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9297 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9298 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9299 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009300
9301 Supported in default-server: No
9302
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009303send-proxy-v2
9304 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9305 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9306 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9307 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9308 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9309 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9310 option of the "bind" keyword.
9311
9312 Supported in default-server: No
9313
9314send-proxy-v2-ssl
9315 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9316 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9317 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9318 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9319 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9320 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9321 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9322 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9323
9324 Supported in default-server: No
9325
9326send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9327 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9328 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9329 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9330 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9331 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9332 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9333 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9334 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9335 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9336
9337 Supported in default-server: No
9338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009339slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009340 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9341 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9342 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9343 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9344 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9345 parameters :
9346
9347 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9348 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9349
9350 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9351 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9352 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9353 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9354
9355 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9356 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9357 seen as failed.
9358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009359 Supported in default-server: Yes
9360
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009361source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009362source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009363source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009364 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9365 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9366 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9367 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9368
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009369 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9370 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9371 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9372 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9373 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9374 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9375 server.
9376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009377 Supported in default-server: No
9378
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009379ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009380 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9381 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9382 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9383 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9384 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9385 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009386 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009387
9388 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009390track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009391 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9392 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9393 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9394 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009395 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009397 Supported in default-server: No
9398
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009399verify [none|required]
9400 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009401 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9402 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9403 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9404 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009405 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9406 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9407 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009408
9409 Supported in default-server: No
9410
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009411verifyhost <hostname>
9412 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9413 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9414 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9415 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9416 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9417 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9418
9419 Supported in default-server: No
9420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009421weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009422 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9423 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9424 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009425 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9426 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9427 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9428 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9429 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9430 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009432 Supported in default-server: Yes
9433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009434
94356. HTTP header manipulation
9436---------------------------
9437
9438In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9439response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9440request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9441which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009442against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009443
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009444If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9445to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9446but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9447HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9448stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9449because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9450a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9451still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009453This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9454in section 4.2 :
9455
9456 - reqadd <string>
9457 - reqallow <search>
9458 - reqiallow <search>
9459 - reqdel <search>
9460 - reqidel <search>
9461 - reqdeny <search>
9462 - reqideny <search>
9463 - reqpass <search>
9464 - reqipass <search>
9465 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9466 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9467 - reqtarpit <search>
9468 - reqitarpit <search>
9469 - rspadd <string>
9470 - rspdel <search>
9471 - rspidel <search>
9472 - rspdeny <search>
9473 - rspideny <search>
9474 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9475 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9476
9477With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9478is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9479parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9480prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9481Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9482
9483 \t for a tab
9484 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9485 \n for a new line (LF)
9486 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9487 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9488 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9489 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9490 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9491
9492The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9493portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9494above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9495regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
94969 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9497is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9498
9499The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9500after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9501
9502Notes related to these keywords :
9503---------------------------------
9504 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9505 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9506 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9507
9508 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9509 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9510 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9511
9512 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9513 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9514 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9515 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9516 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9517
9518 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9519 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9520 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9521 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9522 useless headers before adding new ones.
9523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009524 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009525 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9526
9527 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9528 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9529 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9530
9531 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9532 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009533 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009534
9535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095367. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9537----------------------------------
9538
9539Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9540client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9541The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9542these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9543but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9544data called patterns.
9545
9546
95477.1. ACL basics
9548---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009549
9550The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9551content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9552from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9553simple :
9554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009555 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009556 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009557 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9558 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009560The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9561adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009562
9563In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009565 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009566
9567This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9568Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9569and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009570an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9571conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9572as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9573are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009574
9575ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9576'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9577which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9578
9579There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9580performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009582The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9583specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9584this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009585methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9586ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009587
9588Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9589 - boolean
9590 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9591 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9592 - string
9593 - data block
9594
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009595Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9596converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9597would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9598The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9599which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9600
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009601Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9602keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9603fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9604which are summarized in the table below :
9605
9606 +---------------------+-----------------+
9607 | Sample or converter | Default |
9608 | output type | matching method |
9609 +---------------------+-----------------+
9610 | boolean | bool |
9611 +---------------------+-----------------+
9612 | integer | int |
9613 +---------------------+-----------------+
9614 | ip | ip |
9615 +---------------------+-----------------+
9616 | string | str |
9617 +---------------------+-----------------+
9618 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9619 +---------------------+-----------------+
9620
9621Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9622matching method, see below.
9623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009624The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9625 - boolean
9626 - integer or integer range
9627 - IP address / network
9628 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9629 - regular expression
9630 - hex block
9631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009632The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9633
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009634 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9635 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009637 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009638 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009639 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009640 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009642The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9643read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9644if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9645lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9646will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9647beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9648a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9649lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9650exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9651
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009652The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9653parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9654ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9655a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9656check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9657
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009658The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9659socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9660file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009662Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9663loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9664
9665 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9666
9667In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9668the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9669case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9670as well.
9671
9672The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9673sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9674do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9675methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9676is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9677obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9678followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9679default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9680that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9681string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9682
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009683The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9684By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9685string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9686resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9687server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9688waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9689flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9690function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009692There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9693sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9694be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009695
9696 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9697 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009698 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9699 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9700 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9701 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009702
9703 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9704 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009705 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009706
9707 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009708 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009709
9710 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009711 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009712
9713 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9714 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9715
9716 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9717 binary or string samples.
9718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009719 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9720 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009722 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9723 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9724 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009726 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9727 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009729 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9730 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009732 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9733 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009735 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9736 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009737 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009739 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9740 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9741 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009742
9743For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9744request, it is possible to do :
9745
9746 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9747
9748In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9749buffer, one would use the following acl :
9750
9751 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9752
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009753On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9754possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9755
9756 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009758All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9759criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9760method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9761to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9762criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9763the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009765If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009766the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9767For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009769 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9770 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9771 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9772 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009773
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009774
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009775The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9776types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9777combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9778brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9779default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009781 +-------------------------------------------------+
9782 | Input sample type |
9783 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009784 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009785 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9786 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9787 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009788 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009789 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009790 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009791 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009792 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009793 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009794 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009795 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009796 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009797 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009798 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009799 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009800 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009801 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009802 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009803 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009804 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009805 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009806 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009807 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009808 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009809 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9810 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009812
9813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098147.1.1. Matching booleans
9815------------------------
9816
9817In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9818Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9819When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9820that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9821
9822Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9823return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9824"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9825
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098277.1.2. Matching integers
9828------------------------
9829
9830Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9831enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9832to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9833
9834Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9835matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9836lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009837
9838For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9839unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9840representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9841
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009842As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9843two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9844instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9845ranges and operators.
9846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009847For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009848operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9849Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9850of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009852Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009853
9854 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9855 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9856 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9857 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9858 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009860For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009861
9862 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9863
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009864This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9865
9866 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9867
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098697.1.3. Matching strings
9870-----------------------
9871
9872String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9873different forms :
9874
9875 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9876 patterns ;
9877
9878 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9879 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9880
9881 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9882 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9883
9884 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9885 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9886
9887 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9888 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9889 matches.
9890
9891 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9892 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9893 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009894
9895String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9896exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9897characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9898string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9899to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009900before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009901
9902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099037.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9904---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009905
9906Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9907they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9908possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9909passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9910the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009911the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9912match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009913
9914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099157.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9916-------------------------------------
9917
9918It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9919not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9920a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9921to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9922digits may be used upper or lower case.
9923
9924Example :
9925 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9926 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9927
9928
99297.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9930---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009931
9932IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9933netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9934within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009935host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009936difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9937at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9938does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9939parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009940
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009941IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9942Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9943trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9944IPv6 patterns.
9945
9946HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9947following situations :
9948 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9949 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9950 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9951 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9952 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9953 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9954 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9955 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9956 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9957 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009959
99607.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9961----------------------------------
9962
9963Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9964combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9965
9966 - AND (implicit)
9967 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9968 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009970A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009972 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9975indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009977For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9978"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9979requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9980is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9981
9982 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9983 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9984 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9985 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9986
9987To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9988and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9989
9990 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9991 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9992 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9993 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9994
9995 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9996 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9997 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9998 use_backend www if host_www
9999
10000It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10001expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10002be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10003the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10004
10005 The following rule :
10006
10007 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10008 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10009
10010 Can also be written that way :
10011
10012 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10013
10014It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10015to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10016simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10017sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10018good use is the following :
10019
10020 With named ACLs :
10021
10022 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10023 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10024 monitor fail if site_dead
10025
10026 With anonymous ACLs :
10027
10028 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10029
10030See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10031
10032
100337.3. Fetching samples
10034---------------------
10035
10036Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10037against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10038sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10039ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10040of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10041available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10042
10043This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10044Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10045compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10046deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10047
10048The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10049matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10050method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10051indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10052
10053As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10054when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10055mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10056the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10057ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10058
10059Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10060multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10061when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10062incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10063are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10064is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10065all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10066
10067Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10068 - name
10069 - name(arg1)
10070 - name(arg1,arg2)
10071
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010072
100737.3.1. Converters
10074-----------------
10075
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010076Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10077of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10078is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10079was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10080has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10081unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10082
10083These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10084sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10085the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10086support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010088The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010089
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010090base64
10091 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10092 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10093 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10094
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010095bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10096 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10097 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10098 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10099
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010100djb2([<avalanche>])
10101 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10102 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10103 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10104 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10105 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10106 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10107 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10108 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10109 directive.
10110
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010111field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10112 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10113 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10114 list of chars.
10115
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010116hex
10117 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10118 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10119 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10120 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010122http_date([<offset>])
10123 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10124 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10125 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10126 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10127 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10128 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010130in_table(<table>)
10131 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10132 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10133 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10134 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10135 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10136
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010137ipmask(<mask>)
10138 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10139 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10140 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10141 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10142
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010143json([<input-code>])
10144 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10145 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10146 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10147 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10148 of errors:
10149 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10150 bytes, ...)
10151 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10152 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10153
10154 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10155 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10156 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10157 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10158 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10159 are :
10160 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10161 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10162 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10163 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10164 error ;
10165 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10166 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10167
10168 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10169 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10170
10171 Example:
10172 capture request header user-agent len 150
10173 capture request header Host len 15
10174 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10175
10176 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10177 GET / HTTP/1.0
10178 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10179
10180 Output log:
10181 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10182
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010183language(<value>[,<default>])
10184 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10185 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10186 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10187 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10188 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10189 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10190 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10191 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10192 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10193 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10194 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10195 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010196
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010197 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010198
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010199 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10200 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010201
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010202 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10203 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10204 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10205 use_backend spanish if es
10206 use_backend french if fr
10207 use_backend english if en
10208 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010209
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010210lower
10211 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10212 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10213 type. The result is of type string.
10214
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010215ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10216 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10217 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10218 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10219 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10220 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10221 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10222
10223 Example :
10224
10225 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10226 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10227 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10228
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010229map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10230map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10231map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10232 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10233 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10234 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10235 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10236 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10237 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10238 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10239 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010240
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010241 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10242 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10243 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010244
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010245 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10246 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010247
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010248 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10249 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10250 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10251 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010252 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10253 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010254 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10255 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10256 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10257 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10258 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10259 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10260 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10261 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10262 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10263 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10264 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10265 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10266 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10267 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010268
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010269 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10270 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10271 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10272 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10273 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010274
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010275 Example :
10276
10277 # this is a comment and is ignored
10278 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10279 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10280 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10281 | | | `---------- value
10282 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10283 | `---------------------------- key
10284 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10285
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010286sdbm([<avalanche>])
10287 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10288 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10289 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10290 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10291 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10292 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10293 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10294 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10295 directive.
10296
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010297table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10298 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10299 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10300 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10301 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10302 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10303 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10304
10305
10306table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10307 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10308 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10309 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10310 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10311 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10312 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10313
10314table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10317 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10318 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10319 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10320
10321table_conn_cur(<table>)
10322 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10323 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10324 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10325 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10326 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10327
10328table_conn_rate(<table>)
10329 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10330 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10331 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10332 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10333 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10334
10335table_gpc0(<table>)
10336 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10337 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10338 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10339 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10340 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10341
10342table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10343 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10344 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10345 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10346 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10347 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10348 sample fetch keyword.
10349
10350table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10351 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10352 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10353 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10354 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10355 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10356
10357table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10360 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10361 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10362 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10363 keyword.
10364
10365table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10366 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10367 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10368 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10369 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10370 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10371
10372table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10373 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10374 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10375 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10376 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10377 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10378 keyword.
10379
10380table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10381 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10382 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10383 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10384 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10385 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10386 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10387 keyword.
10388
10389table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10390 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10391 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10392 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10393 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10394 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10395 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10396 keyword.
10397
10398table_server_id(<table>)
10399 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10400 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10401 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10402 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10403 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10404 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10405
10406table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10407 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10408 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10409 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10410 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10411 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10412 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10413 keyword.
10414
10415table_sess_rate(<table>)
10416 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10417 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10418 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10419 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10420 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10421 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10422 keyword.
10423
10424table_trackers(<table>)
10425 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10426 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10427 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10428 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10429 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10430 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10431 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10432 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10433 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10434 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10435
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010436upper
10437 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10438 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10439 type. The result is of type string.
10440
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010441utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10442 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10443 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10444 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10445 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10446 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10447 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10448
10449 Example :
10450
10451 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10452 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10453 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10454
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010455word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10456 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10457 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10458
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010459wt6([<avalanche>])
10460 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10461 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10462 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10463 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10464 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10465 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10466 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10467 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "sdbm", and the "hash-type"
10468 directive.
10469
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010470
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104717.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010472--------------------------------------------
10473
10474A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10475not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10476"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10477The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10478
10479always_false : boolean
10480 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10481 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10482
10483always_true : boolean
10484 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10485 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10486
10487avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010488 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010489 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10490 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10491 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10492 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10493 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10494 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10495 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10496 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10497 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10498 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10499 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10500 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10501 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010503be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010504 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10505 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10506 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10507 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10508 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010510be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10511 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10512 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10513 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10514 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10515 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10516 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010517
10518 Example :
10519 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10520 backend dynamic
10521 mode http
10522 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10523 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010525connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10526 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010527 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010528 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10529 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010530
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010531 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010532 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010533 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10534
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010535 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10536 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010537
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010538 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010539 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010540 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010541 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10542 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010543 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010544 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010545
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010546 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10547 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010548 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010549 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010550
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010551date([<offset>]) : integer
10552 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10553 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10554 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10555 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010556 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10557
10558 Example :
10559
10560 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10561 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010562
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010563env(<name>) : string
10564 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10565 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10566 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10567 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10568 certain way.
10569
10570 Examples :
10571 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10572 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10573
10574 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10575 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10578 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010579 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10580 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10582 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10583 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10584 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10585 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10588 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10589 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10590 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10591 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10592 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10593 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10594 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10595 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010596
10597 Example :
10598 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10599 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10600 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10601 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10602 frontend mail
10603 bind :25
10604 mode tcp
10605 maxconn 100
10606 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10607 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10608 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10609 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010610
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010611nbproc : integer
10612 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10613 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10614 and debugging purposes.
10615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10618 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10619 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010620 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10621 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10622 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010623
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010624proc : integer
10625 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10626 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10627 debugging purposes.
10628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010629queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010630 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10631 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10632 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010633 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10634 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10635 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10636 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10637 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10638
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010639rand([<range>]) : integer
10640 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10641 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10642 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10643 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10644 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010646srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10647 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10648 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10649 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10650 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10651 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10652 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10653 methods.
10654
10655srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10656 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10657 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10658 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10659 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10660 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10661 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10662 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10663
10664srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10665 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10666 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010667 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010668 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10669 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10670 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10671 overloading servers).
10672
10673 Example :
10674 # Redirect to a separate back
10675 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10676 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10677 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10678
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010679stopping : boolean
10680 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10681 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10682 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010684table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10685 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10686 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10687
10688table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10689 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10690 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10691 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10692
10693
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106947.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010695----------------------------------
10696
10697The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10698closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10699methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10700sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10701TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010702the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10703counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10704"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010705argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10706the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10707this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708
10709be_id : integer
10710 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10711 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10712
10713dst : ip
10714 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10715 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10716 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10717 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10718 RFC 4291.
10719
10720dst_conn : integer
10721 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10722 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10723 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10724 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10725 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10726 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10727 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10728 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010730dst_port : integer
10731 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10732 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10733 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10734 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10735 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10736 an HTTP header.
10737
10738fe_id : integer
10739 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10740 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10741 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010743sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010744sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10745sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10746sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010747 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10748 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10749 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10750
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010751sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010752sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10753sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10754sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010755 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10756 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10757 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010759sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010760sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10761sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10762sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010763 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10764 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010765 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10766 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10767 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010768
10769 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10770 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010771 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10772 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10773 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010774 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10775 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010777sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010778sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10779sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10780sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010781 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10782 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10783
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010784sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010785sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10786sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10787sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010788 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10789 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10790 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10791
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010792sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010793sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10794sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10795sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010796 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10797 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10798 See also src_conn_rate.
10799
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010800sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010801sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10802sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10803sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010804 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010805 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010806
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010807sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010808sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10809sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10810sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010811 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10812 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10813 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010814 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10815 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10816 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010817
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010818sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010819sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10820sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10821sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010822 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10823 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10824 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010826sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010827sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10828sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10829sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010830 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10831 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10832 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10833 src_http_err_rate.
10834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010835sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010836sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10837sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10838sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010839 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10840 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10841 src_http_req_cnt.
10842
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010843sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010844sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10845sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10846sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010847 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10848 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10849 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10850 src_http_req_rate.
10851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010852sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010853sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10854sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10855sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010856 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010857 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10858 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10859 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10860 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010861
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010862 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10863 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010864 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10865
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010866sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010867sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10868sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10869sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010870 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10871 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10872 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010874sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010875sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10876sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10877sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010878 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10879 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10880 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010881
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010882sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010883sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10884sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10885sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010886 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10887 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10888 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10889 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010890 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010891 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10892
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010893sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010894sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10895sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10896sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010897 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10898 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10899 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10900 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10901 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010902 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010904sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010905sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10906sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10907sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010908 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10909 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10910 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010912sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010913sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10914sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10915sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010916 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10917 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010918 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010919 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10920 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010921 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10922 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10923 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010925so_id : integer
10926 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10927 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10928 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930src : ip
10931 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10932 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10933 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10934 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10935 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10936 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10937 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010938
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010939 Example:
10940 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10941 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010943src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10944 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10945 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10946 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010947 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10950 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10951 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010952 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010953 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010955src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10956 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10957 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10958 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10959 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10960 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10961 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010962
10963 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10964 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10965 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10966 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010967 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010968 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10969 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010971src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010972 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010973 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010974 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010975 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010977src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010978 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010979 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10980 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010981 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010983src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10984 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10985 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10986 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010987 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010989src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010990 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010991 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010992 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010993 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010995src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010996 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010997 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010998 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10999 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011000 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11001 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11002 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011004src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11005 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11006 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011007 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011008 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011009 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011011src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11012 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11013 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11014 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11015 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011016 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011018src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11019 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11020 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11021 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011022 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011024src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11025 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11026 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11027 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011028 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011029 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011031src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11032 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11033 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11034 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011035 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011036 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11037 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011038
11039 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011040 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011041 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011043src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011044 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11045 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11046 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11047 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11048 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011051 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11052 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11053 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11054 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11055 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057src_port : integer
11058 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11059 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11060 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11061 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011063src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11064 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011065 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11066 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11067 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011068 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011070src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11071 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11072 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11073 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11074 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011075 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011077src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11078 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11079 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11080 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11081 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11082 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11083 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11084 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11085 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011086
11087 Example :
11088 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11089 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11090 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11091 listen ssh
11092 bind :22
11093 mode tcp
11094 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011095 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011096 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011097 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011099srv_id : integer
11100 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11101 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11102 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011103
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011104
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111057.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011106----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011108The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11109closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11110when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11111usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011112future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011113
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011114ssl_bc : boolean
11115 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11116 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11117 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11118
11119ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11120 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11121 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11122
11123ssl_bc_cipher : string
11124 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11125 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11126
11127ssl_bc_protocol : string
11128 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11129 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11130
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011131ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011132 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011133 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11134 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011135
11136ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11137 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11138 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11139 if session was reused or not.
11140
11141ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11142 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11143 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011145ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11146 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11147 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11148 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11149 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11150 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011152ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11153 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11154 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11155 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11156 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011157
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011158ssl_c_der : binary
11159 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11160 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11161 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163ssl_c_err : integer
11164 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11165 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11166 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11167 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11168 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11171 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11172 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11173 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11174 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11175 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11176 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11177 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11178 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011180ssl_c_key_alg : string
11181 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11182 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11183 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011185ssl_c_notafter : string
11186 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11187 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11188 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011190ssl_c_notbefore : string
11191 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11192 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11193 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011195ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11196 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11197 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11198 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11199 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11200 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11201 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11202 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11203 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011205ssl_c_serial : binary
11206 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11207 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11208 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011210ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11211 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11212 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11213 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011214 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11215 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11216
11217 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011219ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11220 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11221 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11222 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011224ssl_c_used : boolean
11225 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11226 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011228ssl_c_verify : integer
11229 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11230 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11231 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11232 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011234ssl_c_version : integer
11235 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11236 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011237
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011238ssl_f_der : binary
11239 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11240 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11241 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011243ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11244 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11245 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11246 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11247 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011248 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011249 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11250 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11251 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011253ssl_f_key_alg : string
11254 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11255 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11256 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011258ssl_f_notafter : string
11259 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11260 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11261 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011263ssl_f_notbefore : string
11264 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11265 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11266 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011268ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11269 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11270 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11271 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11272 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11273 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11274 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11275 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11276 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011278ssl_f_serial : binary
11279 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11280 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11281 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011282
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011283ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11284 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11285 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11286 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011288ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11289 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11290 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11291 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011293ssl_f_version : integer
11294 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11295 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11296
11297ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011298 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11299 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11300 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011302 Example :
11303 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11304 listen http-https
11305 bind :80
11306 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11307 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11308
11309ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11310 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11311 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11312
11313ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011314 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011315 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11316 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11317 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11318 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11319 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11320 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11321 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11322 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011324ssl_fc_cipher : string
11325 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11326 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011329 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11330 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011331 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11332 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11333 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11334 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011336ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11337 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011338 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11339 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11340 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11341 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011343ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011344 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11346 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11347 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11348 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11349 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11350 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11351 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011353ssl_fc_protocol : string
11354 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11355 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011356
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011357ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011358 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011359 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11360 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011362ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11363 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11364 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11365 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11366 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011368ssl_fc_sni : string
11369 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11370 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11371 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11372 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11373 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11374
11375 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11376 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11377 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011378 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11379 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011381 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011382 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11383 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011385ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11386 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11387 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011388
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011389
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200113907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011391------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011393Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11394sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11395only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11396For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11397be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11398can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11399sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11400for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11401content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011403payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11404 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11405 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11406 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11409 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11410 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11411 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011413req.len : integer
11414req_len : integer (deprecated)
11415 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11416 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11417 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11418 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11419 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11420 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11421 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11422 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011424req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11425 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011426 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11427 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11428 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11429 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011431 ACL alternatives :
11432 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011434req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11435 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11436 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11437 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11438 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011440 ACL alternatives :
11441 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011443 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445req.proto_http : boolean
11446req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11447 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11448 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11449 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11450 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11451 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11452 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11453 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011455 Example:
11456 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11457 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11458 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011459 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011461req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11462rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11463 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11464 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11465 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11466 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11467 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11468 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11469 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11472 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11473 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11474 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11475 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11476 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011478 ACL derivatives :
11479 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011481 Example :
11482 listen tse-farm
11483 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11484 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11485 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11486 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11487 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11488 persist rdp-cookie
11489 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11490 # This is only useful makes sense if
11491 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11492 stick-table type string size 204800
11493 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11494 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11495 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011497 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11498 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011500req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11501rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11502 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11503 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11504 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11505 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 ACL derivatives :
11508 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11511req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11512 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11513 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11514 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11515 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11516 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11517 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11518 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011520req.ssl_sni : string
11521req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11522 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11523 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11524 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11525 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11526 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11527 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11528 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11529 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11530 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11531 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11532 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11533 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011535 ACL derivatives :
11536 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011538 Examples :
11539 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11540 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11541 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11542 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11543 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011545res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11546rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11547 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11548 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11549 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11550 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11551 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11552 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11553 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555req.ssl_ver : integer
11556req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11557 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11558 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11559 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11560 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11561 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11562 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11563 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11564 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11565 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011567 ACL derivatives :
11568 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011569
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011570res.len : integer
11571 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11572 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11573 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11574 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11575 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11576 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11577 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11578 content inspection.
11579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011580res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11581 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011582 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11583 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11584 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11585 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011587res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11588 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11589 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11590 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11591 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011593 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011595wait_end : boolean
11596 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11597 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11598 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11599 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11600 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11601 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11602 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11603 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011605 Examples :
11606 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11607 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11608 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011610 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11611 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11612 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11613 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11614 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11615 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11616 tcp-request content reject
11617
11618
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116197.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011620--------------------------------------
11621
11622It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11623This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11624data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11625its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11626HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11627content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11628to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11629more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11630response are indexed.
11631
11632base : string
11633 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11634 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11635 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11636 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11637 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11638 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11639 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11640 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11641
11642 ACL derivatives :
11643 base : exact string match
11644 base_beg : prefix match
11645 base_dir : subdir match
11646 base_dom : domain match
11647 base_end : suffix match
11648 base_len : length match
11649 base_reg : regex match
11650 base_sub : substring match
11651
11652base32 : integer
11653 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11654 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11655 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011656 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11657 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11658 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011659
11660base32+src : binary
11661 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11662 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11663 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11664 per-URL counters.
11665
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011666capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11667 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11668 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11669 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11670
11671capture.req.method : string
11672 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11673 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11674 because it's allocated.
11675
11676capture.req.uri : string
11677 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11678 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11679 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11680 allocated.
11681
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011682capture.req.ver : string
11683 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11684 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11685 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11686
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011687capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11688 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11689 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11690 The first entry is an index of 0.
11691 See also: "capture response header"
11692
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011693capture.res.ver : string
11694 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11695 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11696 persistent flag.
11697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011698req.cook([<name>]) : string
11699cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11700 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11701 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11702 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11703 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11704 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11705 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11706 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11707 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11708
11709 ACL derivatives :
11710 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11711 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11712 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11713 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11714 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11715 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11716 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11717 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011719req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11720cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11721 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11722 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11725cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11726 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11727 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11728 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11729 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011731cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11732 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11733 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11734 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11735 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11736 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11737 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11738 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11739 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11740 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11741 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011743hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11744 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11745 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11746 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11747 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011748 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011750req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11751 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11752 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11753 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11754 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11755 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11756 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11757 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11758 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011760req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11761 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11762 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11763 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11764 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011766req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11767 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11768 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11769 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11770 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11771 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11772 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11773 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11774 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11775 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11776 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11777 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011779 ACL derivatives :
11780 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11781 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11782 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11783 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11784 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11785 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11786 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11787 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11788
11789req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11790hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11791 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11792 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11793 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11794 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11795 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11796 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11797 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11798 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11799 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11800
11801req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11802hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11803 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11804 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11805 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11806 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11807 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11808 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11809 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11810 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11811
11812req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11813hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11814 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11815 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11816 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11817 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11818 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11819 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11820 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11821
11822http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11823 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11824 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11825 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11826 basic auth is supported.
11827
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011828http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11829 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11830 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11831 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11832 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11834 basic auth is supported.
11835
11836 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011837 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11838 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11839 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11840 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011841
11842http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011843 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11844 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11846 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011848method : integer + string
11849 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11850 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11851 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11852 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11853 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11854 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11855 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011857 ACL derivatives :
11858 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011860 Example :
11861 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11862 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11863 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011865path : string
11866 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11867 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11868 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11869 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11870 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11871 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11872 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011874 ACL derivatives :
11875 path : exact string match
11876 path_beg : prefix match
11877 path_dir : subdir match
11878 path_dom : domain match
11879 path_end : suffix match
11880 path_len : length match
11881 path_reg : regex match
11882 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011884req.ver : string
11885req_ver : string (deprecated)
11886 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11887 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11888 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011890 ACL derivatives :
11891 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893res.comp : boolean
11894 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11895 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11896 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011898res.comp_algo : string
11899 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11900 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11901 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011903res.cook([<name>]) : string
11904scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11905 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11906 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11907 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011909 ACL derivatives :
11910 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011912res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11913scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11914 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11915 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11916 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011918res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11919scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11920 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11921 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11922 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11925 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11926 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11927 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11928 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11929 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11930 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11931 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11932 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11933 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011935res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11936 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11937 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11938 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11939 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11940 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011942res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11943shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11944 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11945 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11946 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11947 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11948 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11949 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11950 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11951 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011953 ACL derivatives :
11954 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11955 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11956 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11957 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11958 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11959 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11960 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11961 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11962
11963res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11964shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11965 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11966 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11967 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11968 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11969 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011971res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11972shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11973 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11974 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11975 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11976 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11977 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11978 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011980res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11981shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11982 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11983 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11984 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11985 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11986 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11987 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011989res.ver : string
11990resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11991 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11992 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011994 ACL derivatives :
11995 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011997set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11998 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11999 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12000 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12001 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012003 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12004 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012006 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012008status : integer
12009 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12010 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12011 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012013url : string
12014 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12015 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12016 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12017 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12018 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12019 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12020 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012022 ACL derivatives :
12023 url : exact string match
12024 url_beg : prefix match
12025 url_dir : subdir match
12026 url_dom : domain match
12027 url_end : suffix match
12028 url_len : length match
12029 url_reg : regex match
12030 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012032url_ip : ip
12033 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12034 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12035 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12036 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12037 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12038 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12039 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012041url_port : integer
12042 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12043 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12044 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12045 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012047urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12048url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12049 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12050 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12051 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12052 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12053 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12054 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12055 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12056 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12057 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012059 ACL derivatives :
12060 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12061 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12062 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12063 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12064 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12065 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12066 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12067 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012068
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012070 Example :
12071 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12072 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12073 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12074 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012076urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12077 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12078 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12079 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012080
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120827.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012083---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012085Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12086every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012087order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012089ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12090---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012091FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012092HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012093HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12094HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012095HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12096HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12097HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12098HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12099LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012100METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12101METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12102METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12103METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12104METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12105METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012106RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012107REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012108TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012109WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12110---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012111
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121138. Logging
12114----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012115
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012116One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12117provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12118very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12119provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12120state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012121to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012122headers.
12123
12124In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12125about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12126send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12127
12128 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12129 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12130 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12131 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12132 at the termination.
12133
12134The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12135allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12136as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12137while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12138real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12139delay.
12140
12141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121428.1. Log levels
12143---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012144
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012145TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012146source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012147HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12148in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12149track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12150syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12151about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012152
12153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121548.2. Log formats
12155----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012156
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012157HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012158and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12159slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12160options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012161
12162 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12163 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12164 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12165 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12166 extents.
12167
12168 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12169 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12170 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12171 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12172 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12173
12174 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12175 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12176 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12177 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12178 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12179
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012180 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12181 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12182 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12183 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12184
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012185 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12186
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012187Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12188specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12189field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12190servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12191always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12192identifier.
12193
12194Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12195 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12196 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12197 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12198 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12199
12200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122018.2.1. Default log format
12202-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012203
12204This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12205as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12206format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12207
12208 Example :
12209 listen www
12210 mode http
12211 log global
12212 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12213
12214 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12215 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12216 (www/HTTP)
12217
12218 Field Format Extract from the example above
12219 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12220 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12221 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12222 4 'to' to
12223 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12224 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12225
12226Detailed fields description :
12227 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12228 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12229 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12230 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12231 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12232 and processed the connection.
12233 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12234
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012235In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12236"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12237connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12238
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012239It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12240will eventually disappear.
12241
12242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122438.2.2. TCP log format
12244---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012245
12246The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12247is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12248information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12249counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12250emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12251environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12252the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12253sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012254specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12255not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12256fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12257marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012258
12259 Example :
12260 frontend fnt
12261 mode tcp
12262 option tcplog
12263 log global
12264 default_backend bck
12265
12266 backend bck
12267 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12268
12269 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12270 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12271 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12272
12273 Field Format Extract from the example above
12274 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12275 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12276 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12277 4 frontend_name fnt
12278 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12279 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12280 7 bytes_read* 212
12281 8 termination_state --
12282 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12283 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12284
12285Detailed fields description :
12286 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012287 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12288 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12289 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12290 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12291 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012292
12293 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012294 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12295 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12296 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012297
12298 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12299 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12300 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12301 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12302
12303 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12304 and processed the connection.
12305
12306 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12307 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12308 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12309 applications.
12310
12311 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12312 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12313 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12314 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12315 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12316
12317 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12318 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12319 See "Timers" below for more details.
12320
12321 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12322 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12323 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12324 "Timers" below for more details.
12325
12326 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012327 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012328 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12329 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12330 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12331 details.
12332
12333 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12334 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12335 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12336 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12337 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12338
12339 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12340 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12341 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12342 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12343 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12344 for more details.
12345
12346 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012347 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012348 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12349 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12350 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012351 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012352
12353 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12354 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12355 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12356 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12357 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12358 caused by a denial of service attack.
12359
12360 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12361 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12362 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12363 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12364 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12365 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12366 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12367 denial of service attack.
12368
12369 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12370 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12371 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12372 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12373 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12374 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12375 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12376 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12377 be processed than on other servers.
12378
12379 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12380 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12381 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12382 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12383 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12384 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12385 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12386 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12387 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12388 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12389 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12390 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12391 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12392
12393 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12394 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12395 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12396 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12397 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12398 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12399 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12400 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12401
12402 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12403 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12404 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12405 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12406 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12407 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12408 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12409 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12410 occurs.
12411
12412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124138.2.3. HTTP log format
12414----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012415
12416The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12417is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12418the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12419are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12420emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12421generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12422"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12423which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012424frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12425is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012426
12427Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12428slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12429with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12430
12431 Example :
12432 frontend http-in
12433 mode http
12434 option httplog
12435 log global
12436 default_backend bck
12437
12438 backend static
12439 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12440
12441 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12442 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12443 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012444 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012445
12446 Field Format Extract from the example above
12447 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12448 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12449 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12450 4 frontend_name http-in
12451 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12452 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12453 7 status_code 200
12454 8 bytes_read* 2750
12455 9 captured_request_cookie -
12456 10 captured_response_cookie -
12457 11 termination_state ----
12458 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12459 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12460 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12461 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12462 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012463
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012464
12465Detailed fields description :
12466 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012467 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12468 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12469 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12470 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12471 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012472
12473 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012474 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12475 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12476 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012477
12478 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12479 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12480 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12481 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12482 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12483
12484 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12485 and processed the connection.
12486
12487 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12488 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12489 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12490
12491 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12492 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12493 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12494 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12495 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12496 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12497
12498 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12499 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12500 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12501 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12502 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12503 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12504
12505 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12506 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12507 See "Timers" below for more details.
12508
12509 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12510 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12511 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12512 below for more details.
12513
12514 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12515 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12516 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12517 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12518 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12519 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12520 for more details.
12521
12522 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012523 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012524 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12525 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12526 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12527 details.
12528
12529 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12530 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12531 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12532
12533 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12534 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12535 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12536 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12537 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12538 overflowing.
12539
12540 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12541 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12542 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12543 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12544 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12545 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12546 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12547 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12548
12549 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12550 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12551 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12552 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12553 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12554 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12555 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12556 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12557
12558 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12559 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12560 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12561 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12562 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12563 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12564 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12565
12566 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012567 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012568 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12569 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12570 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012571 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012572 system.
12573
12574 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12575 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12576 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12577 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12578 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12579 caused by a denial of service attack.
12580
12581 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12582 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12583 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12584 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12585 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12586 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12587 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12588 denial of service attack.
12589
12590 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12591 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12592 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12593 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12594 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12595 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12596 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12597 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12598 processed than on other servers.
12599
12600 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12601 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12602 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12603 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12604 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12605 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12606 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12607 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12608 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12609 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12610 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12611 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12612 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12613
12614 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12615 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12616 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12617 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12618 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12619 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12620 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12621 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12622
12623 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12624 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12625 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12626 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12627 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12628 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12629 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12630 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12631 occurs.
12632
12633 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12634 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12635 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12636 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12637 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12638 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12639 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12640 cookies" below for more details.
12641
12642 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12643 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12644 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12645 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12646 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12647 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12648 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12649 and cookies" below for more details.
12650
12651 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12652 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12653 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12654 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12655 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12656 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12657 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12658 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12659
12660
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200126618.2.4. Custom log format
12662------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012663
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012664The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012665mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012666
12667HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12668Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12669separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12670prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12671
12672Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12673variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12674string formats ("Q").
12675
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012676If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012677as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012678less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12679the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12680
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012681Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012682In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012683in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012684
12685Flags are :
12686 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012687 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012688
12689 Example:
12690
12691 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12692 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12693
12694At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12695
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012696 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12697 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012698
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012699the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012700
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012701 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012702 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012703 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012704
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012705and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12706
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012707 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012708 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12709
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012710Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12711
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012712 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012713 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012714 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12715 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12716 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012717 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12718 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12719 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012720 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012721 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012722 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012723 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012724 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012725 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012726 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12727 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012728 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012729 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12730 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012731 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012732 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12733 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012734 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12735 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12736 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012737 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012738 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12739 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012740 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012741 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12742 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12743 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012744 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020012745 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012746 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12747 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12748 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12749 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012750 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012751 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012752 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012753 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012754 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012755 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012756 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12757 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12758 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012759 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012760 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12761 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012762 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012763 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012764 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012765 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012766
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012767 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012768
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012769
127708.2.5. Error log format
12771-----------------------
12772
12773When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12774protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12775By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12776"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12777will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12778logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12779
12780The format looks like this :
12781
12782 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12783 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12784 Connection error during SSL handshake
12785
12786 Field Format Extract from the example above
12787 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12788 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12789 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12790 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12791 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12792
12793These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12794failures.
12795
12796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127978.3. Advanced logging options
12798-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012799
12800Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12801just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12802options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12803for more information about their usage.
12804
12805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12807------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012808
12809It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12810haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12811commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12812monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12813ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12814
12815 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12816 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12817 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12818 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12819
12820 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12821 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12822 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012823 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012824 such as other load-balancers.
12825
12826 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12827 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12828 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12829
12830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128318.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12832----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012833
12834The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12835what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12836or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12837"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12838just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12839log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12840after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12841is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12842with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12843with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12844
12845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128468.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12847------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012848
12849Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12850for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12851"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12852retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12853raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12854a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12855file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12856you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12857"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12858
12859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128608.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12861--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012862
12863Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12864multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12865them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12866"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12867logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12868error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12869and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12870too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12871useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12872alternative.
12873
12874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128758.4. Timing events
12876------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012877
12878Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12879reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12880the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12881frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12882mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12883
12884 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12885 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12886 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12887 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12888 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12889
12890 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12891 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12892 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12893 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12894 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12895
12896 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12897 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12898 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12899 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12900 connection never established.
12901
12902 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12903 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12904 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12905 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12906 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12907 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12908 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12909 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12910 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12911 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12912 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12913
12914 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12915 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12916 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12917 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012918 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012919
12920 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12921
12922 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12923 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12924 negative.
12925
12926These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12927protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12928that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012929due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012930close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12931session has been aborted on timeout.
12932
12933Most common cases :
12934
12935 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12936 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12937 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12938 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12939 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12940 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12941 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12942 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12943 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012944 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12945 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12946 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012947
12948 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12949 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12950 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12951 of ms on remote networks.
12952
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012953 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12954 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12955 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012956
12957 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12958 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12959 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12960 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12961 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12962 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12963 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12964 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12965 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12966 to the server until another one is released.
12967
12968Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12969
12970 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12971 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12972 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12973
12974 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12975 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12976 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12977
12978 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12979 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12980 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12981 flags.
12982
12983 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12984 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12985 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12986 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12987 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12988 the client connection was maintained open.
12989
12990 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012991 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012992 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12993 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12994
12995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129968.5. Session state at disconnection
12997-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012998
12999TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13000"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
130012-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13002each of which has a special meaning :
13003
13004 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13005 session to terminate :
13006
13007 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13008
13009 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13010 server explicitly refused it.
13011
13012 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13013 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13014 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13015 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013016 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13017
13018 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13019 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013020
13021 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13022 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13023 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13024 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13025 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13026
13027 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13028 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13029 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13030 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13031 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13032
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013033 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13034 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13035
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013036 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13037 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13038 backup connections when going up.
13039
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013040 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13041
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013042 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13043 send or receive data.
13044
13045 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13046 send or receive data.
13047
13048 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13049 with nothing left in the buffers.
13050
13051 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13052
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013053 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013054 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13055
13056 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13057 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13058 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13059 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13060 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13061
13062 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13063 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13064
13065 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13066 server (HTTP only).
13067
13068 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13069
13070 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13071 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13072 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13073
13074 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13075 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13076 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13077
13078 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13079
13080 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13081 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13082
13083 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13084 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13085 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13086
13087 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13088 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013089 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13090 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013091
13092 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13093 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13094 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13095 another server.
13096
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013097 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013098 server.
13099
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013100 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13101 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13102 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13103 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13104
13105 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13106 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13107 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13108 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13109
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013110 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13111 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13112 "use-server" rule).
13113
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013114 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13115
13116 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13117 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13118
13119 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13120
13121 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13122 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13123 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13124
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013125 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13126 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013127 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013128 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13129 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13130
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013131 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13132
13133 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13134 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13135
13136 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13137
13138 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13139
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013140The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13141was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013142helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13143starvation, attacks, etc...
13144
13145The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13146alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13147easier finding and understanding.
13148
13149 Flags Reason
13150
13151 -- Normal termination.
13152
13153 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13154 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13155 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13156 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13157
13158 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13159 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13160 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13161 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13162 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13163 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013164
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013165 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13166 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013167 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013168
13169 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13170 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13171 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13172
13173 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13174 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13175 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13176 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13177 the server takes too long to respond.
13178
13179 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13180 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13181 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13182 long a time to respond.
13183
13184 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13185 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13186 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13187 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13188 and the client.
13189
13190 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13191 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13192 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13193 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13194 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013195 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13196 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13197 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13198 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13199 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13200 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13201 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13202 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13203 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13204 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13205 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13206 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13207 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13208 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013209
13210 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13211 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013212 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13213 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13214 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13215 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013216
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013217 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13218 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013220 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013221 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13222 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13223 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13224 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13225 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13226
13227 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13228 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13229 503 or 504 here.
13230
13231 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13232 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13233 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13234 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13235 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13236
13237 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13238 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013239 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013240 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13241 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13242
13243 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13244 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13245 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13246 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13247 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13248 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13249 between haproxy and the server.
13250
13251 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13252 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13253 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13254 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13255 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13256 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13257 solution is to fix the application.
13258
13259 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13260 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13261 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13262 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13263 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13264 external attacks.
13265
13266 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13267 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013268 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013269 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13270 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13271
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013272 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13273 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13274 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013275 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13276 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013277
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013278 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13279 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13280 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13281 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013282 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13283 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13284 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13285 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13286 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013287
13288 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13289 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13290 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13291 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13292
13293 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13294 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13295 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13296 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13297
13298 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13299 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13300 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13301 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13302
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013303The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13304persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13305important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13306re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13307
13308 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13309
13310 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13311 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13312 set on a GET request.
13313
13314 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13315 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013316 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013317 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13318
13319 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13320 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13321 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13322
13323 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13324 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13325 already got a cookie.
13326
13327 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13328 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13329 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13330 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13331 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13332
13333 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13334 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13335 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13336
13337 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13338 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13339 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13340
13341 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13342 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13343
13344 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13345 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13346 then advertised in the response.
13347
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133498.6. Non-printable characters
13350-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013351
13352In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13353consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13354converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13355prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13356being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13357escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13358is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13359'}' when logging headers.
13360
13361Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13362issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13363containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13364
13365Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13366the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13367performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13368
13369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133708.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13371---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013372
13373Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13374achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013375section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013376cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13377the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13378the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013379locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013380not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13381user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13382a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13383wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13384
13385 Examples :
13386 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13387 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13388
13389 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13390 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13391
13392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133938.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13394---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013395
13396Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13397proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13398the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13399server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13400
13401Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13402response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013403section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013404
13405It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013406time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13407appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013408are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13409and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13410follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13411request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13412in the logs.
13413
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013414As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13415frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13416an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13417
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013418 Example :
13419 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13420 listen proxy-out
13421 mode http
13422 option httplog
13423 option logasap
13424 log global
13425 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13426
13427 # log the name of the virtual server
13428 capture request header Host len 20
13429
13430 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13431 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13432
13433 # log the beginning of the referrer
13434 capture request header Referer len 20
13435
13436 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13437 capture response header Server len 20
13438
13439 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13440 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13441
13442 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13443 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13444
13445 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13446 capture response header Via len 20
13447
13448 # log the URL location during a redirection
13449 capture response header Location len 20
13450
13451 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13452 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13453 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13454 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13455 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13456
13457 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13458 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13459 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13460 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013461 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013462
13463 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13464 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13465 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13466 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13467 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013468 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013469
13470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134718.9. Examples of logs
13472---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013473
13474These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13475them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13476reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13477
13478 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13479 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13480 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13481
13482 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13483 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13484
13485 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13486 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13487 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13488
13489 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13490 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13491
13492 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13493 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13494 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13495
13496 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013497 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013498 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13499 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13500
13501 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13502 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13503 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13504
13505 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13506 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013507 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013508 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13509 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13510 to return the 502 and not the server.
13511
13512 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013513 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013514
13515 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13516 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13517 Nothing was sent to any server.
13518
13519 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13520 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13521
13522 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13523 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13524 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13525 send a 408 return code to the client.
13526
13527 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13528 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13529
13530 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13531 5 seconds ("c----").
13532
13533 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13534 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013535 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013536
13537 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013538 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013539 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13540 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13541 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13542 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13543 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013544
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135469. Statistics and monitoring
13547----------------------------
13548
13549It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13550mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13551CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13552Unix socket.
13553
13554
135559.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013556---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013557
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013558The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013559page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13560begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13561represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13562use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13563('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13564(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13565text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13566do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13567use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013568
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013569In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13570that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13571S (Servers).
13572
13573 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13574 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13575 any name for server/listener)
13576 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13577 number queued without a server assigned.
13578 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13579 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13580 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13581 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13582 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13583 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13584 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13585 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13586 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13587 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13588 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13589 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13590 "option checkcache".
13591 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13592 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13593 - read error from the client
13594 - client timeout
13595 - client closed connection
13596 - various bad requests from the client.
13597 - request was tarpitted.
13598 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13599 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13600 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13601 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13602 active servers).
13603 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13604 Some other errors are:
13605 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13606 - failure applying filters to the response.
13607 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13608 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13609 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13610 switched away from.
13611 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13612 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13613 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13614 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13615 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13616 the server is up.)
13617 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13618 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13619 counters for each server.
13620 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13621 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13622 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13623 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13624 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13625 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13626 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13627 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13628 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13629 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13630 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13631 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13632 of times that server was selected.
13633 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13634 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13635 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13636 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13637 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13638 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013639 UNK -> unknown
13640 INI -> initializing
13641 SOCKERR -> socket error
13642 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13643 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13644 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13645 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13646 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13647 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13648 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13649 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13650 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13651 disable-on-404
13652 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13653 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13654 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013655 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13656 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13657 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13658 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13659 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13660 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13661 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13662 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13663 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13664 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13665 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13666 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13667 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13668 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13669 (inc. in eresp)
13670 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13671 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13672 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13673 (CPU/BW limit)
13674 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13675 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13676 server/backend
13677 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13678 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13679 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13680 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13681 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13682 (0 for TCP)
13683 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13684 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013685
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136879.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013688-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013689
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013690The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13691necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13692A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13693issuing commands by hand :
13694
13695 global
13696 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13697 stats timeout 2m
13698
13699It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13700the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13701never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13702situations :
13703
13704 global
13705 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13706 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13707 stats timeout 2m
13708
13709To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13710swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13711to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13712syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13713
13714 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13715 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13716
13717The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13718script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13719for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13720
13721The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13722that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13723editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13724(eg: watch a counter).
13725
13726The socket supports two operation modes :
13727 - interactive
13728 - non-interactive
13729
13730The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13731this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13732sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13733mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13734commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13735example :
13736
13737 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13738
13739The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13740entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13741for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13742sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13743"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13744after processing the last command of the same line.
13745
13746For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13747"prompt" command :
13748
13749 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13750 prompt
13751 > show info
13752 ...
13753 >
13754
13755Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13756delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13757that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13758parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013759
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013760It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13761on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13762own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013763
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013764The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13765If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13766all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13767it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13768
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013769add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013770 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13771 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13772 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13773 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013774
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013775add map <map> <key> <value>
13776 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13777 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013778 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13779 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13780 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013781
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013782clear counters
13783 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13784 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13785 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13786 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13787 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13788
13789clear counters all
13790 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13791 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13792 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13793
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013794clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013795 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13796 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13797 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013798
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013799clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013800 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13801 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13802 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013803
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013804clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13805 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13806
13807 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13808 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13809 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13810 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13811 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13812 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13813
13814 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13815
13816 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13817 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13818 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13819 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13820 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13821 the ACLs :
13822
13823 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13824 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13825 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13826 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13827 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13828 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13829
13830 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013831 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13832 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013833
13834 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013835 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013836 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013837 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13838 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13839 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13840 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013841
13842 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13843
13844 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013845 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013846 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13847 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013848 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13849 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13850 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013851
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013852del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13853 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013854 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13855 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13856 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13857 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013858
13859del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013860 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013861 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13862 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13863 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13864 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013865
13866disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013867 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13868
13869 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13870 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13871 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13872 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13873 re-enabled using enable agent.
13874
13875 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13876 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13877 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13878 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13879 otherwise unchanged.
13880
13881 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13882 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13883 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13884
13885 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13886 level "admin".
13887
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013888disable frontend <frontend>
13889 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13890 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13891 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13892 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13893 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13894 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13895 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13896 on the stats page.
13897
13898 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13899 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13900
13901 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13902 level "admin".
13903
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013904disable health <backend>/<server>
13905 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13906 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13907 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13908 agent check forces it down.
13909
13910 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13911 level "admin".
13912
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013913disable server <backend>/<server>
13914 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13915 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13916 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13917 during the maintenance.
13918
13919 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13920 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13921
13922 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013923 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013924
13925 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13926 level "admin".
13927
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013928enable agent <backend>/<server>
13929 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13930
13931 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13932 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13933
13934 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13935 level "admin".
13936
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013937enable frontend <frontend>
13938 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13939 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13940 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13941 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13942 which was disabled.
13943
13944 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13945 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13946
13947 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13948 level "admin".
13949
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013950enable health <backend>/<server>
13951 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13952 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13953
13954 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13955 level "admin".
13956
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013957enable server <backend>/<server>
13958 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13959 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13960
13961 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013962 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013963
13964 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13965 level "admin".
13966
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013967get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013968get acl <acl> <value>
13969 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13970 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13971 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13972 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13973 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013974
13975 The first two words are:
13976
13977 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13978 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13979 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13980
13981 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13982
13983 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13984
13985 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13986
13987 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13988 interpretation of the case.
13989
13990 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13991 useful with regular expressions.
13992
13993 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13994 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13995
13996 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13997 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13998 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13999
14000 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014002get weight <backend>/<server>
14003 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14004 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14005 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14006 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14007 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014008 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014009
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014010help
14011 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14012 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014013
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014014prompt
14015 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14016 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14017 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14018 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14019 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14020 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14021 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14022 command.
14023
14024quit
14025 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014026
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014027set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014028 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14029 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14030 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014031
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014032set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014033 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14034 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14035 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14036 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14037 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014038 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14039 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14040
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014041set maxconn global <maxconn>
14042 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14043 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14044 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14045 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14046 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14047 setting.
14048
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014049set rate-limit connections global <value>
14050 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14051 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14052 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14053 is passed in number of connections per second.
14054
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014055set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14056 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14057 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014058 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14059 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014060
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014061set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14062 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14063 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14064 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14065 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14066
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014067set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14068 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14069 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14070 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14071 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14072 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14073
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014074set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14075 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14076 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14077 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14078
14079set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14080 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14081 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14082 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14083
14084set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14085 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14086 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14087 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14088 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14089 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14090 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14091 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14092 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14093
14094set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14095 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14096 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14097
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014098set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14099 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14100 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14101 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14102 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14103
14104 Example:
14105 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14106 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14107 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14108 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14109
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014110set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014111 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14112 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14113 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14114 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014115 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14116 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014117
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014118set timeout cli <delay>
14119 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14120 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14121 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14122
14123set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14124 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14125 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014126 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14127 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14128 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14129 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14130 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14131 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14132 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14133 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14134 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14135 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14136 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14137 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14138 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014139
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014140show errors [<iid>]
14141 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14142 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014143 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14144 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14145 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014146
14147 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14148 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14149 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14150 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14151 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14152 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14153 are reported too.
14154
14155 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14156 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14157 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14158 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14159 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14160 code.
14161
14162 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14163 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14164 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14165 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14166 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14167 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14168 line.
14169
14170 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014171 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14172 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014173 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14174 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14175
14176 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14177 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14178 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14179 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14180 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14181 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14182 00204+ minal\r\n
14183 00211 \r\n
14184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014185 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014186 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14187 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14188 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14189 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14190 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14191 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014192
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014193show info
14194 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14195
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014196show map [<map>]
14197 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014198 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14199 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14200 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14201 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14202 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14203 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014204
14205show acl [<acl>]
14206 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014207 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14208 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14209 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14210 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14211 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014212
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014213show pools
14214 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14215 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14216 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14217 the pools.
14218
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014219show sess
14220 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014221 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14222 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14223
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014224show sess <id>
14225 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14226 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14227 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14228 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14229 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014230 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14231 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14232
14233 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14234 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014235
14236show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14237 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14238 possible to dump only selected items :
14239 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14240 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14241 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14242 for example:
14243 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14244 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14245 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14246
14247 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014248 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14249 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014250 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14251 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14252 Nbproc: 1
14253 Process_num: 1
14254 (...)
14255
14256 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14257 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14258 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14259 (...)
14260 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14261
14262 $
14263
14264 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14265 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14266 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14267 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014268 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014269
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014270show table
14271 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14272 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14273 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14274 entries currently in use.
14275
14276 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014277 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014278 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14279 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014280
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014281show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014282 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14283 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14284 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014285 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14286
14287 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14288 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14289 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14290 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14291 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14292
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014293 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14294 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14295 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14296 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14297 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14298 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14299
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014300
14301 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014302 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14303 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014304
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014305 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014306 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014307 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014308 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14309 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14310 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14311 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014312
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014313 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014314 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014315 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14316 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014317
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014318 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14319 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014320 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014321 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14322 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014323
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014324 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14325 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014326 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014327 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14328 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14329
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014330 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14331 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14332 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14333 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14334 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14335
14336 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14337 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14338 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014339 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14340 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014341 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14342 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014343
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014344shutdown frontend <frontend>
14345 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14346 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14347 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14348 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14349 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14350 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14351 once it is terminated.
14352
14353 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14354 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14355
14356 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14357 level "admin".
14358
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014359shutdown session <id>
14360 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14361 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14362 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14363 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14364 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14365 flag in the logs.
14366
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014367shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014368 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14369 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14370 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14371 'K' flag in the logs.
14372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014373/*
14374 * Local variables:
14375 * fill-column: 79
14376 * End:
14377 */